Psion Teklogix Laptop 7530 G2 User Manual

7530 G2 Hand-Held  
Computer  
User Manual  
June 21, 2006  
Part No. 8000081.A  
ISO 9001 Certified  
Quality Management System  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
© Copyright 2006 by Psion Teklogix Inc., Mississauga, Ontario  
This document and the information it contains is the property of Psion Teklogix Inc.,  
is issued in strict confidence, and is not to be reproduced or copied, in whole or in  
part, except for the sole purpose of promoting the sale of Teklogix manufactured  
goods and services. Furthermore, this document is not to be used as a basis for  
design, manufacture, or sub-contract, or in any manner detrimental to the interests  
of Psion Teklogix Inc.  
All trademarks are the property of their respective holders.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Return-To-Factory Warranty  
Psion Teklogix Inc. provides a return to factory warranty on this product for a period  
of twelve (12) months in accordance with the Statement of Limited Warranty and  
Limitation of Liability provided at www.psionteklogix.com/warranty. (If you are not  
already a member of Teknet and you attempt to view this warranty, you will be asked  
to register. As a member of Teknet, you will have access to helpful information about  
your Psion Teklogix products at no charge to you.) In some regions, this warranty  
may exceed this period. Please contact your local Psion Teklogix office for details.  
For a list of offices, see Appendix A: “Support Services And Worldwide Offices”.  
The warranty on Psion Teklogix manufactured equipment does not extend to any  
product that has been tampered with, altered, or repaired by any person other than an  
employee of an authorized Psion Teklogix service organization. See Psion Teklogix  
terms and conditions of sale for full details.  
Important:Psion Teklogix warranties take effect on the date of shipment.  
Service  
Psion Teklogix provides a complete range of product support services to its custom-  
ers. For detailed information, please refer to Appendix A: “Support Services And  
Worldwide Offices”. This section also provides information about accessing support  
services through the Psion Teklogix web site.  
Waste Electrical and Electronic Equipment (WEEE) Directive  
2002/96/EC  
This Product, and its accessories, comply with the requirements of the Waste Electri-  
cal and Electronic Equipment (WEEE) Directive 2002/96/EC. If your end-of-life  
Psion Teklogix product or accessory carries a label as shown here, please contact  
your local country representative for details on how to arrange recycling.  
For a list of international subsidiaries, please go to:  
www.psionteklogix.com/public.aspx?s=us&p=Contacts.  
Restriction On Hazardous Substances (RoHS) Directive 2002/95/EC  
What is RoHS?  
The European Union has mandated that high environmental standards be met in the  
design and manufacture of electronic and electrical products sold in Europe, to reduce  
hazardous substances from entering the environment. The “Restriction on Hazardous  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Substances Directive (RoHS)” prescribes the maximum trace levels of lead, cad-  
mium, mercury, hexavalent chromium, and flame retardants PBB and PBDE that  
may be contained in a product. Only products meeting these high environmental  
standards may be “placed on the market” in EU member states after July 1, 2006.  
RoHS Logo  
Although there is no legal requirement to mark RoHS-compliant products, Psion  
Teklogix Inc. indicates its compliance with the directive as follows:  
The RoHS logo located either on the back of the product or underneath the battery in  
the battery compartment (or on a related accessory such as the charger or docking  
station) signifies that the product is RoHS-compliant as per the EU directive. Other  
than as noted below, a Psion Teklogix product that does not have an accompanying  
RoHS logo signifies that it was placed on the EU market prior to July 1, 2006, and is  
thereby exempt from the directive.  
Note: Not all accessories or peripherals will have a RoHS logo due to physical  
space limitations or as a result of their exempt status.  
Disclaimer  
Every effort has been made to make this material complete, accurate, and up-to-  
date. In addition, changes are periodically added to the information herein; these  
changes will be incorporated into new editions of the publication.  
Psion Teklogix Inc. reserves the right to make improvements and/or changes in the  
product(s) and/or the program(s) described in this document without notice, and  
shall not be responsible for any damages, including but not limited to consequential  
damages, caused by reliance on the material presented, including but not limited to  
typographical errors.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TABLE OF CONTENTS  
1.2 Text Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4  
2.3.1 Assigning An IP Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23  
2.3.2 Name Servers Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24  
2.3.3 Advanced Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25  
2.4 Checking The Scanner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26  
2.5 Using Microsoft ActiveSync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26  
2.6 Resetting The Hand-Held . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
i
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
3.8 Monitoring The Battery And Maximizing Run Time . . . . . . . . . . 53  
3.8.1 Storing Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54  
3.9 Monitoring The Network Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55  
3.10 Uploading Data In A Docking Station. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55  
3.11 General Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56  
3.11.1 Caring For The Touchscreen. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56  
ii  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.4.4 Shortcuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69  
5.6.4 Power Management Properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102  
5.6.5 Stylus Properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107  
5.6.6 Manage Triggers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109  
5.6.7 Certificate Assignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113  
5.7 Bluetooth Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114  
5.7.1 The Devices Tab. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
5.12 SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) Setup. . . . . . . . .204  
Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
6.1 External Bar Code Readers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215  
6.1.1 PowerScan™ Standard, LR and XLR Bar Code Scanners . . .215  
6.1.2 Entering Data With The Bar Code Reader. . . . . . . . . . . .215  
6.2 RD7950 Integrated UHF RFID Reader . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215  
6.3 Batteries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215  
iv  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6.11.2 Wiring Guidelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230  
6.11.3 Using The Picker Cradle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230  
6.11.4 Maintaining The Picker Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230  
6.11.5 Powered Cradle Installation In High Voltage Vehicles . . . . . 231  
6.11.6 Powered Cradle Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231  
6.11.7 The Port Replicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
7.6.3 SE 1224HP Scanner Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243  
7.8 2400 mAh Lithium-Ion Battery Pack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248  
Appendix B: Port Pinouts  
B.5 JB5 To RS-232 Serial Cable - PN CA1010 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .B-3  
Appendix C: USB Setup Application  
C.1 USB Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .C-1  
C.1.1 Launching The Application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .C-2  
C.1.2 Installation Complete Dialog Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .C-3  
vi  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PROGRAM LICENSE AGREEMENTS  
Microsoft's End User License Agreement  
You have acquired a device (“DEVICE”) that includes software licensed by Psion Teklogix  
Inc. from Microsoft Licensing Inc. or its affiliates (‘MS”). Those installed software products  
of MS origin, as well as associated media, printed materials, and “online” or electronic doc-  
umentation (“SOFTWARE”) are protected by international intellectual property laws and  
treaties. The SOFTWARE is licensed, not sold. All rights reserved.  
IF YOU DO NOT AGREE TO THIS END USER LICENSE AGREEMENT (“EULA”),  
DO NOT USE THE DEVICE OR COPY THE SOFTWARE. INSTEAD, PROMPTLY  
CONTACT PSION TEKLOGIX INC. FOR INSTRUCTIONS ON RETURN OF THE  
UNUSED DEVICE(S) FOR A REFUND. ANY USE OF THE SOFTWARE, INCLUD-  
ING BUT NOT LIMITED TO USE ON THE DEVICE, WILL CONSTITUTE YOUR  
AGREEMENT TO THIS EULA (OR RATIFICATION OF ANY PREVIOUS CON-  
SENT).  
GRANT OF SOFTWARE LICENSE. This EULA grants you the following license:  
You may use the SOFTWARE only on the DEVICE.  
NOT FAULT TOLERANT. THE SOFTWARE IS NOT FAULT TOLERANT.  
PSION TEKLOGIX INC. HAS INDEPENDENTLY DETERMINED HOW TO  
USE THE SOFTWARE IN THE DEVICE, AND MS HAS RELIED UPON  
PSION TEKLOGIX INC. TO CONDUCT SUFFICIENT TESTING TO DETER-  
MINE THAT THE SOFTWARE IS SUITABLE FOR SUCH USE.  
NO WARRANTIES FOR THE SOFTWARE. THE SOFTWARE is provided  
“AS IS” and with all faults. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO SATISFACTORY  
QUALITY, PERFORMANCE, ACCURACY, AND EFFORT (INCLUDING  
LACK OF NEGLIGENCE) IS WITH YOU. ALSO, THERE IS NO WAR-  
RANTY AGAINST INTERFERENCE WITH YOUR ENJOYMENT OF  
THE SOFTWARE OR AGAINST INFRINGEMENT. IF YOU HAVE  
RECEIVED ANY WARRANTIES REGARDING THE DEVICE OR THE SOFT-  
WARE, THOSE WARRANTIES DO NOT ORIGINATE FROM, AND ARE NOT  
BINDING ON, MS.  
Note on Java Support. The SOFTWARE may contain support for programs  
written in Java. Java technology is not fault tolerant and is not designed, manufac-  
tured, or intended for use or resale as online control equipment in hazardous envi-  
ronments requiring fail-safe performance, such as in the operation of nuclear  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
I
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
License Agreement  
facilities, aircraft navigation or communication systems, air traffic control, direct  
life support machines, or weapons systems, in which the failure of Java technology  
could lead directly to death, personal injury, or severe physical or environmental  
damage. Sun Microsystems, Inc. has contractually obligated MS to make this dis-  
claimer.  
No Liability for Certain Damages. EXCEPT AS PROHIBITED BY LAW, MS  
SHALL HAVE NO LIABILITY FOR ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL, CONSE-  
QUENTIAL OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES ARISING FROM OR IN CON-  
NECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THE SOFTWARE.  
THIS LIMITATION SHALL APPLY EVEN IF ANY REMEDY FAILS OF  
ITS ESSENTIAL PURPOSE. IN NO EVENT SHALL MS BE LIABLE FOR  
ANY AMOUNT IN EXCESS OF U.S. TWO HUNDRED FIFTY DOLLARS  
(U.S.$250.OO).  
Limitations on Reverse Engineering, Decompilation, and Disassembly. You  
may not reverse engineer, decompile, or disassemble the SOFTWARE, except and  
only to the extent that such activity is expressly permitted by applicable law not-  
withstanding this limitation.  
SOFTWARE TRANSFER ALLOWED BUT WITH RESTRICTIONS. You  
may permanently transfer rights under this EULA only as part of a permanent sale  
or transfer of the Device, and only if the recipient agrees to this EULA. If the  
SOFTWARE is an upgrade, any transfer must also include all prior versions of the  
SOFTWARE.  
EXPORT RESTRICTIONS. You acknowledge that SOFTWARE is subject to  
U.S. export jurisdiction. You agree to comply with all applicable international and  
national laws that apply to the SOFTWARE, including the U.S. Export Administra-  
tion Regulations, as well as end-user, end-use and destination restrictions issued by  
U.S. and other governments. For additional information see  
http://www.microsoft.com/exporting/.  
Psion Teklogix Inc. End User License Agreement  
IMPORTANT – READ CAREFULLY:  
This License Agreement (“Agreement”) is a legal agreement between you and Psion Tek-  
logix (“we”), the licensor of this software package (“Software”), for your use of the Soft-  
ware only as authorized in this Agreement.  
By clicking on the “Accept” or other appropriate assent button and/or installing the Soft-  
ware, you agree to be and are hereby bound by the terms and conditions of this Agreement.  
If you do not agree with this Agreement, we do not grant you a license to the Software, and  
you may not install or use the Software or any accompanying documentation.  
II  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
License Agreement  
The Software is the property of Psion Teklogix Inc. or its licensors and is protected by copy-  
right laws and international copyright treaties, as well as other intellectual property laws and  
treaties. The Software is licensed, not sold. Psion Teklogix Inc. provides the Software and  
licenses its use worldwide. You assume responsibility for the selection of the Software to  
achieve your intended results, and for the use and results obtained from it.  
1. GRANT OF LICENSE  
We hereby grant you and you hereby accept a non-exclusive, non-transferable, limited  
license to install and use the Software in object code form only, subject to the terms and  
restrictions set forth in this Agreement. Except as explicitly set forth below, (i) you are not  
permitted to copy, sell, lease or rent, distribute or sublicense the Software or to use the Soft-  
ware in a time-sharing arrangement or in any other unauthorized manner; (ii) no license is  
granted to you in the human readable code of the Software (source code); and (iii) this  
Agreement does not grant you any rights to patents, copyrights, trade secrets, trademarks,  
intellectual property or any other ownership rights with respect to the Software.  
2. DESCRIPTION OF REQUIREMENTS, RESTRICTIONS, RIGHTS AND  
LIMITATIONS  
a.  
Copy. The right and license granted to you shall be limited to installation and use  
of the Software up to but not exceeding the number of copies you have licensed.  
However, you may make a copy of the Software for backup or archival purposes.  
You shall not remove any copyright notice or proprietary notices, labels or marks  
in or on the Software.  
b.  
c.  
Evaluation. As part of evaluation, you may install and use the Software only  
during the specified evaluation period. Unless you register the license as  
described below, the evaluation license shall expire upon the expiration of the  
evaluation period.  
License Registration. You will be required to provide a license ID, unique to  
each device, for registering your Software license. As part of your software  
license registration, we will provide you a corresponding license key for each  
device.  
d.  
No Modifications. You may not modify or create any derivative work of the  
Software or any copy or portion thereof nor may you remove any Software iden-  
tification, copyright or other notices.  
e.  
f.  
No Distribution. You may not distribute the Software, in whole or in part, to any  
other third party.  
Virus Program. You may not develop or knowingly incorporate any virus pro-  
gram that may be harmful to a computer or a network in conjunction with the  
Software, or use the Software for any other purpose as which may be harmful to  
a third party.  
g.  
h.  
Assignment. You may not assign or transfer the Software to a third party or  
allow a third party to use the same.  
Reverse Engineering. Modification, reverse engineering, reverse compiling,  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
III  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
License Agreement  
disassembly, unbundling or extraction of the Software is expressly prohibited.  
i.  
Export Restrictions. You agree to comply with all applicable laws and regula-  
tions and that you will not export or re-export the Software, or any part or copies  
thereof, or any products utilizing the Software in violation of applicable laws or  
regulations of the United States or the country in which you obtained them.  
3. HIGH RISK ACTIVITIES  
The Software is not fault-tolerant and is not designed, manufactured or intended for use or  
resale as on-line control equipment in hazardous environments requiring fail-safe perfor-  
mance, such as in the operation of nuclear facilities, aircraft navigation or communication  
systems, air traffic control, direct life support machines, or weapons systems, in which the  
failure of the Software could lead to death, personal injury, or severe physical or environ-  
mental damage (“High Risk Activities”). We specifically disclaim any express or implied  
warranty of fitness for High Risk Activities.  
4. DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTY  
We do not warrant uninterrupted or error free operation of the Software nor do we warrant  
that the Software will meet your requirements. THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS-IS”  
WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY WHATSOEVER AND WITHOUT ANY TECHNICAL  
SUPPORT OF ANY KIND. WE DISCLAIM ANY AND ALL REPRESENTATIONS,  
WARRANTIES AND CONDITIONS, WHETHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUD-  
ING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF  
MERCHANTABLE QUALITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. WE DO  
NOT WARRANT OR MAKE ANY REPRESENTATIONS REGARDING THE USE OR  
THE RESULTS OF THE USE OF THE SOFTWARE IN TERMS OF ITS CORRECT-  
NESS, ACCURACY, RELIABILITY, USE WITH FUTURE PSION TEKLOGIX  
DEVICES INTRODUCED, OR OTHERWISE. YOU EXPRESSLY ACKNOWLEDGE  
AND AGREE THAT USE OF THE SOFTWARE IS AT YOUR SOLE RISK AND YOU  
ARE RESPONSIBLE FOR INSTALLATION OF THE SOFTWARE ON YOUR COM-  
PUTER.  
5. LIMITATION OF LIABILITY  
We are liable for no more than the value of the license fee that you paid for the Software.  
This limitation is cumulative and our responsibility for multiple claims will not exceed in  
aggregate this limit.  
Under no circumstances are we or our third party suppliers liable for damages of third parties  
claimed against you, or for harm to your records or data, or special, incidental, indirect, or  
consequential damages, including but not limited to lost profits, lost business revenue or fail-  
ure to realize expected savings, loss of data, loss of use of the Software or any associated  
equipment, downtime and user’s time, even if you informed us of their possibility, or for  
breach of any express or implied warranty, breach of contract, negligence, strict liability or  
any other legal theory related to the Software. This limitation applies whether you are enti-  
tled to claim damages from us or our third party suppliers as a matter of contract or tort.  
IV  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
License Agreement  
6. COPYRIGHTS, OWNERSHIP AND PROPRIETARY RIGHTS  
All title and copyrights in and to the Software, and any copies thereof, are owned by Psion  
Teklogix Inc. or its suppliers. The Software also contains copyrighted material licensed from  
our suppliers or obtained from open source and all rights to such copyrighted material rests  
with such suppliers. Additional third party license terms and conditions may apply. We  
retain title to the Software and any copies made from it. Any copies of the Software you  
made are subject to the restrictions of this Agreement.  
WE DISCLAIM ALL WARRANTIES AND INDEMNITIES, EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR  
STATUTORY, FOR PATENT OR COPYRIGHT INFRINGEMENT.  
7. CONFIDENTIALITY  
You agree not to use or disclose any proprietary information provided by us, except for the  
purposes of this Agreement. You agree not to reproduce any of the copyrighted materials  
unless expressly permitted by this Agreement.  
8. ENDING THIS AGREEMENT  
We may terminate this Agreement and your license immediately without notice if (a) you  
fail to comply with any term of this Agreement, or (b) your rights are assigned by you, by  
operation of law or otherwise. In such event, you must return or destroy all copies and com-  
ponent parts of the Software and documentation, as well as any other Psion Teklogix propri-  
etary information in your possession, within fourteen (14) days of the date of termination.  
Any rights and obligations under this Agreement that by their nature continue after it ends  
will remain in effect until they are completed.  
9. GENERAL  
The laws of the Province of Ontario and the federal laws applicable therein, excluding the  
conflict of laws provisions, govern this Agreement. If any provision of this Agreement is  
deemed invalid or unenforceable by any country, that particular provision will be deemed  
modified to the extent necessary to make the provision valid and enforceable, and the  
remaining provisions will remain in full force and effect. Failure by us to insist on strict per-  
formance or to exercise a right when entitled, does not prevent us from doing so at a later  
time, either in relation to that default or any subsequent one.  
No modifications of this Agreement shall be effective unless in writing and approved by us.  
You acknowledge that you have read this Agreement, understand it, and that it is the com-  
plete agreement between you and Psion Teklogix with respect to the subject matter hereof  
and supersedes all prior agreements, oral or written.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
V
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
APPROVAL AND SAFETY SUMMARY  
FCC DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY (DoC)  
Applicant’s Name & Address:  
PSION TEKLOGIX  
2100 Meadowvale Blvd.  
Mississauga, Ontario  
Canada L5N 7J9  
Contact Person: Iain Roy  
Telephone No.: (905) 813-9900  
US Representative’s Name & Address:  
1810 Airport Exchange Blvd., Suite 500  
Erlanger, KY, 41018, USA  
Contact Person: Kyle Day  
Telephone No.: (859) 372-4329  
Equipment Type/Environment:  
Computing Devices  
Trade Name / Model No.:  
7530 G2 Hand-Held Micro-computer with  
Portable Docking Module  
Year of Manufacture:  
2006  
Standard(s) to which Conformity is Declared:  
The 7530 G2 Hand Held Micro-computer with Portable Docking Module, supplied by  
Psion Teklogix, has been tested and found to comply with FCC PART 15, SUBPART B -  
UNINTENTIONAL RADIATORS, CLASS B COMPUTING DEVICES FOR  
HOME & OFFICE USE.  
I, the undersigned, hereby declare that the equipment as tested is representative within  
manufacturing tolerance to units.  
Applicant  
Legal Representative in U.S.  
Signature  
Signature  
Mike Doyle  
Kyle Day  
Full Name  
Full Name  
Vice President, Engineering  
Vice President, Channel Sales  
Position  
Position  
Mississauga, Ontario, Canada  
Erlanger, KY 41018, USA  
Place  
Place  
June 2006  
Date  
June 2006  
Date  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
VII  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Approvals And Safety Summary  
CE Marking  
When used in a residential, commercial or light industrial environment the product  
and its approved UK and European peripherals fulfil all requirements for CE marking.  
R&TTE Directive 1999/5/EC  
This equipment complies with the essential requirements of EU Directive  
1999/5/EC (Declaration available: www.psionteklogix.com).  
Cet équipement est conforme aux principales caractéristiques définies dans la  
Directive européenne RTTE 1999/5/CE. (Déclaration disponible sur le site:  
www.psionteklogix.com).  
Die Geräte erfüllen die grundlegenden Anforderungen der RTTE-Richtlinie  
(1999/5/EG). (Den Wortlaut der Richtlinie finden Sie unter:  
www.psionteklogix.com).  
Questa apparecchiatura è conforme ai requisiti essenziali della Direttiva Europea  
R&TTE 1999/5/CE. (Dichiarazione disponibile sul sito: www.psionteklogix.com).  
Este equipo cumple los requisitos principales de la Directiva 1995/5/CE de la UE,  
“Equipos de Terminales de Radio y Telecomu-nicaciones”. (Declaración disponible  
en: www.psionteklogix.com).  
Este equipamento cumpre os requisitos essenciais da Directiva 1999/5/CE do  
Parlamento Europeu e do Conselho (Directiva RTT). (Declaração disponível no  
endereço: www.psionteklogix.com).  
Ο εξοπλισμός αυτός πληροί τις βασικές απαιτήσεις της κοινοτικής οδηγίας EU  
R&TTE 1999/5/EΚ. (Η δήλωση συμμόρφωσης διατίθεται στη διεύθυνση:  
www.psionteklogix.com)  
Deze apparatuur voldoet aan de noodzakelijke vereisten van EU-richtlijn  
betreffende radioapparatuur en telecommunicatie-eindappa-ratuur 199/5/EG.  
(verklaring beschikbaar: www.psionteklogix.com).  
Dette udstyr opfylder de Væsentlige krav i EU's direktiv 1999/5/EC om Radio- og  
teleterminaludstyr. (Erklæring findes på: www.psionteklogix.com).  
Dette utstyret er i overensstemmelse med hovedkravene i R&TTE-direktivet  
(1999/5/EC) fra EU. (Erklæring finnes på: www.psionteklogix.com).  
Utrustningen uppfyller kraven för EU-direktivet 1999/5/EC om ansluten  
teleutrustning och ömsesidigt erkännande av utrustningens överensstämmelse  
(R&TTE). (Förklaringen finns att läsa på: www.psionteklogix.com).  
VIII Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Approvals And Safety Summary  
Tämä laite vastaa EU:n radio- ja telepäätelaitedirektiivin (EU R&TTE Directive  
1999/5/EC) vaatimuksia. (Julkilausuma nähtävillä osoitteessa:  
www.psionteklogix.com).  
Psion Teklogix tímto prohlašuje, že 7530 G2 je ve shodě se základními požadavky a  
dalšími příslušnými ustanoveními směrnice 1995/5/ES (NV č. 426/2000 Sb.) a  
Prohlášení o shodě je k dispozici na www.psionteklogix.com. Toto zarízení lze  
provozovat v České republice na základě generální licence č. GL-12/R/2000.  
Psion Teklogix týmto vyhlasuje, že 7530 G2 spĺňa základné požiadavky a všetky  
príslušné ustanovenia Smernice 1995/5/ES (NV č. 443/2001 Z.z.) a Vyhlásenie o  
zhode je k dispozícii na www.psionteklogix.com. Toto zariadenie je možné  
prevádzkovat’ v Slovenskej republike na základe Všeobecného povolenia č. VPR-  
01/2001.  
L
Use of the 802.11g 7530 G2 Hand-Held in France:  
Owing to French Government restrictions, the 802.11g 7530 G2 Hand-Held  
Computer is limited to indoor use. It may be used outdoors, on private property,  
only with prior authorization from the French Ministry of Defense.  
FCC Information To Users  
Federal Communication Commission Interference Statement  
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B  
digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to  
provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential  
installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy  
and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful  
interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that  
interference will not occur in a particular installation.  
If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception,  
which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is  
encouraged to try to correct the interference by one of the following measures:  
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.  
Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.  
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which  
the receiver is connected.  
Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
IX  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Approvals And Safety Summary  
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the  
following two conditions:  
1. This device may not cause harmful interference, and  
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interfer-  
ence that may cause undesired operation.  
FCC Caution: Any changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party  
responsible for compliance could void the user's authority to operate this equipment.  
IMPORTANT NOTE:  
FCC Radiation Exposure Statement:  
This equipment complies with FCC radiation exposure limits set forth for an  
uncontrolled environment under 47 CFR 2.1093 paragraph (d)(2), for use in a PDA.  
End users must follow the specific operating instructions for satisfying RF  
exposure compliance.  
This transmitter must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other  
antenna or transmitter.  
Some equipment in hospitals and aircraft are not shielded from radio frequency  
energy. Do not use the 7530 G2 hand-held onboard aircraft, or in hospitals, without  
first obtaining permission.  
Do not use near pacemakers. The product may affect the operation of some  
medically implanted devices such as pacemakers, causing them to malfunction.  
Avoid placing your product next to such devices. Keep a minimum distance of 20  
cm between the device and the product to reduce the risk of interference. If you have  
any reason to suspect that interference is taking place, turn off the 7530 G2 hand-  
held and contact your cardiologist for assistance.  
Note: To maintain compliance with the FCC RF exposure guidelines, if  
you wear the 7530 G2 on your body, use the Psion Teklogix approved  
carrying case.  
Use of non-approved accessories may violate FCC RF exposure guidelines.  
X
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Approvals And Safety Summary  
Emissions Information For Canada  
This Class B digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian Interference-  
Causing Equipment Regulations. When using the 802.11 radio option, to prevent  
radio interference, this device is intended to be operated indoors and away from  
windows to provide maximum shielding. Equipment (or its transmit antenna) that is  
installed outdoors is subject to licensing.  
Cet appareil numérique de la classe B respecte toutes les exigences du Règlement  
sur le matériel brouilleur du Canada. En cas d’utilisation du module radio 802.11,  
afin d'éviter toute interférence radio avec le service autorisé, l'appareil doit être  
utilisé à l'intérieur, tout en tant éloigné de toute fenêtre afin de garantir le maximum  
de protection. Si cet équipement (ou son antenne émettrice) est installé à l'extérieur,  
il est alors soumis à licence.  
Warning to Users  
This product is a Class I/Class II laser product according to CDRH 21 CFR 1040.10  
and 1040.11 and Class1/Class 2 laser product according to IEC 60825-  
1:1993+A1:1997+A2:2001.  
LASER WARNINGS  
For your own safety, it is critical that you comply with the following warnings:  
CAUTION  
Do not look into the laser beam or point the beam at people or animals.  
CAUTION  
Using controls or adjustments, or performing procedures other than those  
specified herein may result in hazardous radiation exposure.  
CAUTION  
The use of optical instruments (magnification devices) with this product  
will increase eye hazard.  
DO NOT OPERATE IN AN EXPLOSIVE ATMOSPHERE  
Operating Psion Teklogix equipment where explosive gas is present may  
result in an explosion.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
XI  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Approvals And Safety Summary  
DO NOT REMOVE COVERS OR OPEN ENCLOSURES  
To avoid injury, the equipment covers and enclosures should only be  
removed by qualified service personnel. Do not operate the equipment  
without the covers and enclosures properly installed.  
CAUTION!  
Danger of explosion if a 7530 G2 battery is incorrectly handled, charged,  
disposed of or replaced. Replace only with the same or equivalent type  
recommended by the manufacturer. Dispose of used batteries according to  
the instructions described in “Lithium-Ion Battery Safety Precautions” on  
page XII. Carefully review all battery safety issues.  
VORSICHT!  
Explosiongefahr bei unsachgemäßem Austausch der Batterie Ersatz nur  
durch denselben oder einen vom Hersteller empfohlenen gleichwertigen  
Typ. Entsorgung gebrauchter Batterien nach Angaben des Herstellers.  
LITHIUM-ION BATTERY SAFETY PRECAUTIONS  
Important: Before charging or using the battery pack, it is critical that the  
safety information in this section is reviewed and that all warn-  
ings are strictly followed.  
Warning:  
BATTERIES ARE CONSIDERED HAZARDOUS WASTE and  
must be returned to Psion Teklogix for proper disposal. Forward all  
used batteries to one of the following offices:  
Psion Teklogix Inc.  
2100 Meadowvale Blvd.  
Mississauga, Ontario  
Canada  
Psion Teklogix Corp.  
1810 Airport Exchange Blvd.  
Suite 500  
Erlanger, Kentucky  
USA 41018  
L5N 7J9  
Psion Teklogix S.A.  
La Duranne, 135 Rue Rene Descartes  
BP 421000, 13591 Aix-En-Provence  
Cedex 3; France  
XII  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Approvals And Safety Summary  
Warning:  
TO PREVENT the battery from leaking acid, generating heat or  
exploding, adhere to precautions listed below.  
• The battery incorporates built-in safety devices. To ensure  
their proper function, do not disassemble or alter any parts  
of the battery.  
• Do not short-circuit the battery by directly connecting any of the  
exposed terminals with metal objects such as wire. Do not trans-  
port or store the battery together with metal objects such as neck-  
laces, hair pins, etc.  
• Do not dispose of batteries in fire.  
• Do not use or leave the battery near a heat source such as a fire  
or heater.  
• Do not immerse the battery in water.  
• When charging, use the battery charger specifically designed for  
the battery.  
• Do not pierce, strike, throw or step on the battery.  
• Do not directly solder the battery.  
• Do not connect the battery to an electrical outlet, vehicle  
cigarette lighter, etc.  
• Do not put battery into a microwave oven or pressurized con-  
tainer.  
• Do not use the battery in combination with primary batteries (such  
as dry-cell batteries) or batteries of different capacities or brands.  
• Immediately remove the battery from the device or battery  
charger and stop use if the battery gives off an odor, generates  
heat, becomes discoloured or deformed, or in any way appears  
abnormal during use.  
• Do not continue charging the battery if it does not recharge within  
the specified charge time.  
• The battery may burst or ignite if the battery leaks. Always ensure  
that it is away from any exposed flames.  
• If leaking electrolyte sprays into your eyes, rinse them with clean  
running water, and immediately seek medical attention.  
• Do not store the battery in extremely high temperatures (e.g., a  
vehicle, strong direct sunlight, etc.). This may cause the battery to  
overheat or ignite, and it may also reduce the performance and  
service life of the battery.  
• Do not use in areas where static electricity is greater than what the  
manufacturer guarantees.  
• Keep batteries out of reach of children.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
XIII  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Approvals And Safety Summary  
• Always switch the unit off before changing the battery. While the  
battery is being replaced, the 7530 G2 will save its current data for  
at least 10 minutes.  
IMPORTANT CHARGER AND AC/DC ADAPTOR SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS  
SAVE THESE INSTRUCTIONS – This manual contains important safety  
and operating instructions for battery chargers and AC/DC adaptors.  
Before using the battery charger or AC/DC adaptor, read all instructions and  
cautionary markings on the (1) AC/DC adaptor, (2) battery charger, (3) bat-  
tery, and (4) product using the battery.  
The mains power cord shall comply with national safety regulations of the  
country where the equipment is to be sold.  
Use of an attachment not recommended or sold by the battery charger or  
AC/DC adaptor manufacturer may result in fire, electric shock, or  
personal injury.  
To reduce risk of damage to the electric plug and cord when unplugging the  
charger or AC/DC adaptor, pull the plug rather than the cord.  
Make sure the cord is positioned so that it is not stepped on, tripped over,  
or otherwise subjected to damage or stress.  
Do not operate the charger or AC/DC adaptor with a damaged cord or plug.  
Replace immediately.  
Do not operate the charger or AC/DC adaptor if it has received a sharp blow,  
been dropped, or otherwise damaged in any way; it should be inspected by  
qualified service personnel.  
Do not disassemble the charger or AC/DC adaptor; it should be repaired by  
qualified service personnel. Incorrect reassembly may result in electric shock  
or fire.  
To reduce risk of electric shock, unplug the charger or AC/DC adaptor from  
the outlet before attempting any maintenance or cleaning.  
An extension cord should not be used unless absolutely necessary. Use of an  
improper extension cord could result in fire or electric shock.  
If an extension cord must be used, make sure:  
The plug pins on the extension cord are the same number, size,  
and shape as those on the charger or AC/DC adaptor.  
The extension cord is properly wired and in good electrical  
condition and that the wire size is larger than 16 AWG.  
Do not expose the charger or AC/DC adaptor to rain or snow.  
XIV Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Approvals And Safety Summary  
Do not use the charger if, after an overnight charge, any of the batteries feel  
warmer than the charger housing. The charger should be inspected by  
qualified service personnel.  
Do not use the charger if any of the batteries or the charger get more than  
lukewarm. Do not use the AC/DC adaptor if it gets more than lukewarm. The  
equipment should be inspected by qualified personnel.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
XV  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1.1 About This Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3  
1.2 Text Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4  
1.3 7530 G2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4  
1.4 About The 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7  
1.4.1 The 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8  
1.4.2 Regulatory Labels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 1: Introduction  
About This Manual  
This manual describes how to configure, operate and maintain the Psion Teklogix  
7530 G2 hand-held computer.  
Chapter 1: Introduction  
provides a basic overview of the 7530 G2 hand-held.  
describes the steps required to get the 7530 G2 ready for operation.  
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
describes the 7530 G2 features and outlines how to charge and maintain the bat-  
tery. This chapter also provides a description of the keyboard, how to navigate  
in Microsoft Windows CE, how to use the internal scanner, and so on.  
Chapter 4: Working With Windows CE  
describes the Microsoft Windows CE desktop and how to use it. This chapter  
also outlines the basics of moving around a Windows CE window, selecting and  
opening icons, files, folders and working with a Windows dialog box.  
Chapter 5: Configuration  
provides a description of the Windows CE Control Panel and how to use it to  
configure the 7530 G2, along with the scanners attached to the hand-held,  
and so on.  
Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
describes the peripherals and accessories available for your 7530 G2 hand-held.  
Chapter 7: Specifications  
details radio, hand-held computer and battery specifications.  
Appendix A: Support Services And Worldwide Offices  
provides helpdesk phone numbers and provides web-based information to help  
you search for worldwide office addresses and phone numbers.  
Appendix B: Port Pinouts  
includes 7530 G2 pinouts.  
Appendix C: USB Setup Application  
provides detailed instructions on USB application setup.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 1: Introduction  
Text Conventions  
1.2 Text Conventions  
Note: Notes highlight additional helpful information.  
Important: These statements provide particularly important instructions  
or additional information that is critical to the operation of  
the equipment.  
Warning:  
These statements provide critical information that may prevent  
physical injury, equipment damage or data loss.  
1.3 7530 G2 Features  
Rugged design:  
• IP67 rating protects against dust and temporary water immersion.  
• drop rating up to 2 meters (6.5 feet) onto concrete.  
Processor and memory:  
• 520 MHz XScale PXA 270 processor  
• On-board RAM: 128MB SDRAM  
• On-board ROM: 64MB FLASH  
Operating System:  
• Windows CE 5.0  
Programming environment:  
• HTML, XML  
• Mobile Devices SDK  
• CE.NET SDK  
• Java, Visual C++  
• Standard protocol APIs - Windows sockets (WinCE)  
Wireless communications:  
• IEEE 802.11g 54Mbps 2.4 GHz Compact Flash radio  
• Narrow Band 403-512 MHz PC Card radio  
• On-board Bluetooth radio 2.4 GHz (10m range)  
4
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 1: Introduction  
7530 G2 Features  
Application software:  
• Internet Explorer 6 for CE  
• Wordpad  
• Active Sync  
• Optimized for use with Open TekTerm V2.0  
• ANSI  
• TESS terminal emulations  
• IBM 3270, IBM 5250, HP 2392  
User Interface:  
• Display:  
-
-
-
-
-
320 x 240 (1/4 VGA) graphic colour TFT  
3.5" diagonal portrait mode  
64K displayable colours  
Contrast control and automatic backlight  
Sunlight readable (for outdoor use)  
• Keyboards:  
-
-
-
-
-
2 formats available  
37-key large button (10 F-keys)  
63-key alpha (10 F-keys)  
Illuminated with EL backlight  
Ergonomic design with ambidextrous one-hand operation with  
dual [ENTER] keys  
-
-
Dedicated function keys  
Hard-capped keys  
• Touchscreen options:  
-
Passive stylus or finger operation  
-
Signature capture  
-
Integral stylus holder  
-
Ultra-rugged 5-wire technology  
• Sound:  
-
Voice Features - speaker and mic  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 1: Introduction  
7530 G2 Features  
Indicators and controls:  
• Internal speaker & beeper with volume control, internal mic  
• Multicolour LEDs for radio transmit/receive, scanning, battery status,  
user applications  
Internal Bar Code Scanners:  
• 1D & 2D scan engines:  
• Standard  
• Long Range  
• Advanced Long Range  
• Enhanced Standard Range (Fuzzy Logic)  
• PDF417 Raster Laser  
• 1D Auto-Ranging  
• 1D Standard Imager  
• 2D Standard Imager  
RFID Applications (future release):  
• Tethered reader/writer  
• Multi-protocol support @ 900MHz/ 868 MHz (future)  
Internal expansion slots:  
• One SD I/O (MultiMediaCard) slot  
• One Type II Compact Flash slot  
• One Type III Extended PC Card slot  
External ports:  
• Tether port with:  
-
-
-
RS232 serial  
decoded/undecoded scanner, printer  
USB host  
• Docking Station Port with:  
-
-
-
-
RS232 serial  
USB device support  
USB host support  
Power in/out  
6
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 1: Introduction  
About The 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer  
Freezer option:  
• Heated scan window to reduce fogging  
• Internal heat control optimizes low temperature performance and  
battery life  
Power management:  
• Up to 12 hr usage Li-Ion standard battery (reduced in  
freezer applications)  
• Optional High capacity battery (up to 17 hrs) (reduced in  
freezer applications)  
• Quick swap packs  
• Advanced Smart Battery with gas gauge  
• Built-in fast charger (2hrs)  
• System backup during battery swap (15 min)  
• 1 week real-time clock backup  
Network Management And Security:  
• SNMP MIB 2 support  
• Remote software download  
• Remote WLAN management  
• Enhanced security for 802.11  
1.4 About The 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer  
The 7530 G2 is a rugged, Windows CE based hand-held computer. It is designed to  
withstand the harshest mobile environments including cold environments like  
freezers, ports and yards. It supports wide area mobile applications and is built using  
industry standards-based software and hardware components, making it easy to  
integrate existing or future site infrastructures.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 1: Introduction  
The 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer  
1.4.1 The 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer  
Figure 1.1 7530 G2 With 63-Key Keyboard  
8
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 1: Introduction  
Regulatory Labels  
Tether Port  
Docking Port  
Figure 1.2 7530 G2 Ports  
1.4.2 Regulatory Labels  
MODEL No: 7530 G2 Handheld  
LASER RADIATION  
DO NOT STARE INTO BEAM  
CLASS 2 LASER PRODUCT (IEC)  
CLASS II LASER PRODUCT (CDRH)  
610-680nm LASER (LED)DIODE  
Max.Output:1.4mW (SCAN ) <1mW(AIM)  
IEC 60825-1:1993+A1:1997+A2:2001  
1080259E  
This label is affixed below the scanner window.  
Figure 1.3 Laser Warning Label  
MODEL No: 7530 G2 Handheld  
This product contains an imager  
that uses an LED light source  
to illuminate barcodes  
LED RADIATION  
CLASS 1 LED PRODUCT (IEC)  
CLASS I LED PRODUCT (CDRH)  
IEC 60825-1:1993+A1:1997+A2:2001  
Figure 1.4 LED Radiation Notice Label  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BASIC CHECKOUT  
2.3.2 Name Servers Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24  
2.3.3.1 Rearranging Preferred Networks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25  
2.3.3.2 Deleting A Preferred Network. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25  
2.3.3.3 Changing Network Properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26  
2.4 Checking The Scanner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26  
2.5 Using Microsoft ActiveSync . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26  
2.6 Resetting The Hand-Held . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 2: Basic Checkout  
Preparing The 7530 G2 For Operation  
2.1 Preparing The 7530 G2 For Operation  
Typically, 7530 G2 hand-helds are configured at the factory and arrive ready for use.  
Although these hand-helds are equipped with an internal Compact Flash and SD I/O  
slot, these slots are not intended for user modification. If a device needs to be  
changed or added in these slots, contact qualified Psion Teklogix personnel. Refer to  
Appendix A: Support Services And Worldwide Offices for service information.  
2.1.1 Equipment You Need To Get Started  
You’ll need:  
A compatible battery charger, docking station or portable docking module  
(PDM) with power supply.  
An operating wireless network (if you are not operating the equipment in  
batch mode).  
pistol grip handle).  
2.1.2 Charging The Battery  
Important: The 7530 G2 uses a high capacity Lithium-Ion battery. It is criti-  
cal that you review the battery safety guidelines in “Lithium-Ion  
Battery Safety Precautions” on page XII before charging  
the battery.  
Batteries shipped from the factory are not charged. They must be fully charged prior  
to use. Full capacity may not be reached until at least 5 full charge/discharge cycles  
have been performed.  
Batteries can be charged using a gang charger or the unit’s internal charger. When  
using the internal charger, a suitable power source is required. All chargers and  
docking stations are described in Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
beginning on page 213.  
Note: The 7530 G2 Battery Properties dialog box may indicate an incorrect bat-  
tery capacity until the new battery has been fully charged.  
It may take several charge/discharge cycles for the battery capacity  
gauge to register capacity with the full 95% accuracy.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 2: Basic Checkout  
Installing The Battery  
2.1.3 Installing The Battery  
Slide the charged battery with the contoured plastic facing you into the unit.  
Click the battery into place.  
Keep in mind that if you are using a docking station, you can insert an uncharged  
battery in the hand-held, dock the unit and switch it on. If you are using a PDM, you  
can configure your unit without a battery, with a charged battery or with an  
uncharged battery.  
Important: Accidental removal and insertion of the battery during operation  
may result in the 7530 G2 not booting up normally. Should this  
occur, remove the battery and allow the internal backup power  
supply to deplete – approximately 15 minutes. Unsaved data may  
be lost.  
2.1.4 Switching On The Hand-Held  
To switch the unit on:  
Press and hold down the [ENTER/ON] key for at least one second.  
When all four LEDs flash yellow, release the [ENTER/ON] button.  
A splash screen of the Psion Teklogix logo and the Windows CE logo appears.  
When Windows CE has successfully loaded, the startup desktop is displayed.  
Note: The screen may go blank for a few seconds after the splash screen loading  
bar reaches the end. This is part of the normal Windows CE cold boot  
process. The desktop is displayed after a few moments.  
14  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 2: Basic Checkout  
Attaching Carrying Accessories  
2.1.5 Attaching Carrying Accessories  
Psion Teklogix recommends that a carrying accessory – a handstrap, pistol grip or  
shoulder strap – be installed on the 7530 G2 before use. If your hand-held is not  
fitted with a handstrap or pistol grip, you can install either using the carrying  
accessory kit supplied. You’ll need:  
A Phillips head screwdriver.  
Important: Do not use adhesives such as Loctite to secure screws on carrying  
accessories. These chemicals may damage the plastic casing.  
2.1.5.1 Attaching The Handstrap  
Two Phillips head screws are provided with the handstrap.  
Attach the strap to the two threaded inserts located at the back of the  
7530 G2 near the top of the unit.  
Stretch the handstrap toward the base of the 7530 G2, and hook the bottom  
of the handstrap into the slot near the base of the battery pack.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 2: Basic Checkout  
Attaching The Pistol Grip  
2.1.5.2 Attaching The Pistol Grip  
Note: A Phillips head screwdriver is required.  
The pistol grip is attached to the back of the 7530 G2 using the four threaded inserts  
in the upper part of the 7530 G2 casing. Four black #4-40 Phillips head screws are  
provided with this accessory.  
Note: Prior to installation, make sure the trigger mechanism is securely  
snapped into the pistol grip body and that the trigger operates properly.  
Position the pistol grip so that it fits snugly over the back of the unit and  
the inserts on the back of the hand-held are aligned with the holes in the  
pistol grip.  
Using a Phillips screwdriver, securely fasten the pistol grip to the back of  
the 7530 G2.  
2.2 Calibrating The Touchscreen  
Your 7530 G2 touchscreen will need to be calibrated. Refer to “Calibrating The  
Touchscreen” on page 41 for details.  
16  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 2: Basic Checkout  
Configuring An IEEE 802.11 Radio In The Unit  
2.3 Configuring An IEEE 802.11 Radio In The Unit  
The most common 802.11 settings are configured as defaults. However, there are  
some fields that must be completed, including the SSID of your access point and the  
security methods implemented in the network (including access keys).  
Important: If the 7530 G2 is equipped with a radio that has never been con-  
figured, the radio settings dialog box opens automatically when  
the unit is powered on. In this case, skip to Step 4 on page 19.  
Note: In most situations, the configuration of your 802.11 radio will require  
parameter setting and access keys from a network administrator.  
Network administrators should review the detailed security information in  
this section in order to effectively configure the 802.11 wireless network.  
To configure the 802.11 radio:  
1. Press on [BLUE][0] to display the Start Menu.  
Tap on Settings>Network and Dial-up Connections.  
If you’re using the keyboard, press [BLUE] [0] to display the Start  
Menu. Use the [DOWN] arrow key to highlight Settings. Press the  
[RIGHT] arrow key to display the sub-menu. Highlight Network, and  
press [ENTER].  
Figure 2.1 Network And Dial-Up Connections  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 2: Basic Checkout  
Configuring An IEEE 802.11 Radio In The Unit  
2. Choose the radio icon to open the 802.11 Wireless LAN Settings  
window – in the sample screen, this is labelled PTXCF8385P N1.  
Figure 2.2 802.11 Wireless LAN Settings Window  
3. Wireless Statistics Tab  
When you choose the Wireless LAN icon, an 802.11 Wireless LAN Set-  
tings window (PTXCF8385P N1 in the sample below) is displayed.  
Figure 2.3 Wireless Statistics  
This tab lists your radio statistics. Choosing the Zero button resets the  
statistics of the last four items – Packets IN, Packets OUT, IN errors and  
OUT errors.  
Display the next tab in this window – Wireless Information.  
18  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 2: Basic Checkout  
Configuring An IEEE 802.11 Radio In The Unit  
4. Wireless Information Tab  
The options under this tab display existing networks to which you can  
connect, and it allows you to add a new network or modify the settings  
for an existing network.  
Note: Configure button – To change the settings in an existing network, high-  
light the network you want to modify, and tap on the Configure button to  
display the Wireless Properties dialog box.  
Connect button To force connection to a specific, existing network,  
highlight the network to which you want your 7530 G2 to connect, and  
tap on the Connect button.  
Figure 2.4 Wireless Information Tab  
This tab lists available networks – any access points that are broadcasting  
an SSID, and it lists preferred networks – networks that you have config-  
ured. Since access points are generally secure, they will most likely not  
be listed here. By default, 7530 G2 attempts to connect to preferred net-  
works. This behaviour can be changed by enabling Automatically connect  
to non-preferred networks in the Advanced dialog box (page 25).  
To add a new configuration, tap on the Add New button. A blank Wire-  
less Properties dialog box is displayed.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 2: Basic Checkout  
Configuring An IEEE 802.11 Radio In The Unit  
5. Wireless Properties  
Figure 2.5 Wireless Properties Dialog Box  
Network name (SSID):  
Type the appropriate SSID (Service Set Identifier) in the Network name  
(SSID) text box at the top of this dialog box.  
The Network name field can contain a maximum of 32 characters. The  
name assigned here is listed as a preferred network.  
Important: Keep in mind that the 7530 G2 will only communicate with access  
points that are configured with the same SSID.  
Ad Hoc And Infrastructure:  
If you are using an Infrastructure network – one in which 7530 G2s must  
pass data through an access point – leave the checkbox next to This is an  
ad hoc network blank.  
If you are using an Ad Hoc network – a network in which 7530 G2s pass  
data directly to other 7530 G2s without an access point – add a checkmark  
in the checkbox next to This is an ad hoc network to enable Ad Hoc.  
Encryption  
WEP (Wired-Equivalent Privacy) encryption prevents others from acciden-  
tally accessing your network. If you are not using encryption, you can  
choose Disabled from the dropdown encryption menu. Otherwise, leave  
this field as is.  
20  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 2: Basic Checkout  
Configuring An IEEE 802.11 Radio In The Unit  
Note: WEP cannot be disabled if you are using WPA or WPA-PSK authentication.  
TKIP (Temporal Key Integrity Protocol) is an encryption protocol included  
as part of the IEEE 802.11 standard for wireless LANs. Designed to  
enhance WEP, TKIP uses the original WEP encryption but ‘wraps’ addi-  
tional code at the beginning and end to encapsulate and modify it, encrypt-  
ing each data packet with a unique encryption key.  
Authentication  
802.11 supports four subtypes of network authentication services: Open,  
Shared, WPA, and WPA-PSK. Under Open authentication, any wireless  
station can request authentication. The station that needs to authenticate  
with another wireless station sends an authentication management frame  
that contains the identity of the sending station. The receiving station then  
sends back a frame that indicates whether it recognizes the identity of the  
sending station.  
Under Shared authentication, each wireless station is assumed to have  
received a secret shared key over a secure channel that is independent from  
the 802.11 wireless network communications channel.  
Under WPA and WPA-PSK authentication, the use of 802.1x authentication  
is required. For wireless networks without a Remote Authentication Dial-In  
User Service (RADIUS) infrastructure, WPA supports the use of a pre-  
shared key. For wireless networks with a RADIUS infrastructure, Extensi-  
ble Authentication Protocol (EAP) and RADIUS is supported.  
Network Key:  
This text box is used to specify a 5 or 13 ASCII character sequence or an  
equivalent 10 or 26 Hexadecimal digit sequence that matches the active  
WEP key on the access point.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 2: Basic Checkout  
Configuring An IEEE 802.11 Radio In The Unit  
To assign a Network key, highlight The key is provided automatically,  
and uncheck the checkbox to disable this option.  
Disable this option to  
access Network Key &  
Key Index fields.  
Figure 2.6 Accessing Network Key And Key Index  
Key Index:  
This field is used to identify the WEP key.  
Enter a value from 1 to 4.  
Enable 802.1x authentication:  
802.1X is the IEEE standard that offers additional security for local area  
networks. It provides authentication for user devices attached to an Ethernet  
network, whether wired or wireless. A security protocol packet such as TLS  
or MD5 encapsulated in an EAP is used in conjunction with the 802.1X  
standard to authenticate users at the MAC layer. Available EAPs are listed  
in the dropdown menu next to the EAP option.  
To activate 802.1X, highlight 802.1x authentication, and check  
the checkbox.  
EAP Type (Extensible Authentication Protocol):  
This dropdown menu lists the EAP types available on your system. The  
items in this dropdown menu will vary depending on your network setup.  
Keep in mind also that some authentication protocols require that you select  
a Certificate. By selecting the Properties button, you will be able to select a  
Certificate. “Certificate Assignment” on page 113 provides a website that  
outlines how to create certificates for your network.  
22  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 2: Basic Checkout  
Assigning An IP Address  
6. Saving and exiting the radio setup.  
Once you’ve completed the configuration, press [ENTER], or tap  
on OK.  
The connection you created will be listed in the Wireless Information tab as a  
preferred network. The radio will search for the SSID and will compare the WEP  
and authentication information you specified. If there is a match between your hand-  
held settings and the access point settings, the hand-held will communicate on the  
network through the access point.  
2.3.1 Assigning An IP Address  
If your network is not using a DHCP server, you will need to assign an IP address.  
In the PTXCF8385P N1 Settings window, display the IP Information tab.  
Figure 2.7 IP Information  
Note: Tapping the Renew button forces the 7530 G2 to renew or find a new  
IP address. This is useful if, for example, you are out of communication  
range for a longer period of time and your 7530 G2 is dropped from  
the network.  
To define a static IP address:  
Tap on the Configure button.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 2: Basic Checkout  
Name Servers Tab  
Figure 2.8 Defining An IP Address  
Tap the stylus on the radio button next to Specify an IP address to select it.  
Type an IP, Subnet Mask and Default Gateway address in the appropriate  
fields. Press [ENTER] to save your information.  
2.3.2 Name Servers Tab  
Note: If DHCP is enabled, name server addresses are assigned automatically.  
In the PTXCF8385P N1 Settings window, display the IP Information tab.  
In the IP Information tab, tap on the Configure button.  
Tap on the Name Servers tab to display it.  
Figure 2.9 Name Servers Tab  
The DNS and WINS fields in the Name Servers tab allow you to specify additional  
WINS and DNS resolvers. The format for these fields is ###.###.###.###.  
24  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 2: Basic Checkout  
Advanced Features  
2.3.3 Advanced Features  
To display the Advanced Wireless Settings dialog box:  
Tap on the Advanced button in the Wireless Information tab. (see  
Figure 2.4 on page 19).  
This window lists the available preferred networks.  
Figure 2.10 Advanced Settings  
2.3.3.1 Rearranging Preferred Networks  
The 7530 G2 attempts to connect with the networks listed in this dialog box in  
sequence, beginning at the top of the list. If you need to rearrange this list of  
networks – move networks up and down in the list:  
Tap in the Networks List, and highlight the network that you want to move  
up or down in the list.  
To move the highlighted item in the list upward or downward, tap on the Up  
or Down button.  
2.3.3.2 Deleting A Preferred Network  
To delete a network from this list:  
In the networks list, highlight the network that you want to remove.  
Tap on the Delete button.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 2: Basic Checkout  
Changing Network Properties  
2.3.3.3 Changing Network Properties  
To change the properties of an existing preferred network:  
Highlight the network that you want to modify.  
Make any necessary changes in the Wireless Properties dialog box, and  
press [ENTER] to save the changes.  
2.4 Checking The Scanner  
Note: Details about operating and troubleshooting scanners, Imagers and  
RFID readers are provided under the heading “Internal Scanners” on  
page 48.  
If your 7530 G2 is equipped with an internal scanner, you can test it to ensure that it is  
operating properly. Point the scanner window at a bar code that your scanner was  
designed to decode—for example, a 1D UPC bar code or 2D bar code. Press the  
SCAN button or pistol trigger, and check for a valid decode on the hand-held’s screen.  
Performance is improved if you disable all unneeded bar codes in the Bar Codes  
screen. Review “Scanner Settings” on page 143 for details about  
bar codes.  
ActiveSync – Microsoft PC connectivity software – can be used to connect the  
hand-held to PCs running this software.  
Note: Keep in mind that you’ll need to run the USB Setup program to  
configure your workstation before connecting the 7530 G2 via USB.  
For information about the USB application, refer to Appendix C: USB  
Setup Application.  
By connecting the 7530 G2 to a PC with a cable and running ActiveSync on the PC,  
you can:  
View 7530 G2 files from Windows Explorer.  
Drag and drop files between the 7530 G2 and the PC in the same way that  
you would between PC drives.  
Back up 7530 G2 files to the PC, then restore them from the PC to the hand-  
held again, if needed, and so on.  
To install ActiveSync, follow the step-by-step instructions provided with the  
program’s setup wizard. Refer to the following website for details:  
http://www.microsoft.com/windowsmobile/resources/downloads/pocketpc/activesync35.mspx  
26  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 2: Basic Checkout  
Resetting The Hand-Held  
2.6 Resetting The Hand-Held  
Warm Reset  
To execute a warm reset:  
Press and hold down the [BLUE] key and the [ENTER/ON] key simulta-  
neously for a minimum of six seconds.  
A warm reset closes open applications; any unsaved data are lost. Installed  
programs and saved data are preserved.  
Note: You do not need to reset your 7530 G2 after configuring the radio.  
Cold Reset  
There are two options when executing a cold reset: reset to BootLoader or reset  
directly to Windows CE operating system.  
To execute a cold reset and access the BooSt menu:  
Press and hold down the left [BLUE] key, the [ENTER] key and the  
[SCAN] key simultaneously for a minimum of six seconds.  
After a cold reset, the BooSt menu appears.  
If you want to load the Windows CE operating system, type 1.  
If you want a clean start, press ! (that is, the [SHIFT] key and 1). All data  
and settings are lost. Files and data stored in flash are preserved.  
Once the OS loads, any executables and cab files in the startup folders are run. The  
cab files are deleted by the cab file installer unless they are marked read-only.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.5.2 Onscreen Indicators. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45  
3.5.3 Audio Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47  
3.5.3.1 Adjusting The Beeper Volume. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48  
3.6 Internal Scanners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48  
3.6.1 Scanning Techniques . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49  
3.6.2 Scan LED Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50  
3.6.3 Troubleshooting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
3.8.1 Storing Batteries. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54  
3.9 Monitoring The Network Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55  
3.10 Uploading Data In A Docking Station . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55  
3.11 General Maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56  
3.11.1 Caring For The Touchscreen. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56  
3.11.2 Cleaning The 7530 G2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56  
30  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
Features Of The 7530 G2  
3.1 Features Of The 7530 G2  
Stylus  
(Pointing Tool)  
Sound Port  
7530 G2 Screen  
Ambient Light  
Sensor  
Microphone  
Beeper Port  
Figure 3.1 Front Of 7530 G2  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
The Battery  
3.2 The Battery  
The hand-held operates with a Lithium-Ion battery pack. Preparing the unit for  
operation requires that a battery pack be charged and installed in the 7530 G2.  
3.2.1 Battery Safety  
Important: Before attempting to install, use or charge the battery pack, it is  
critical that you review and follow the important safety guidelines  
in the section entitled “Lithium-Ion Battery Safety Precautions”  
on page XII.  
3.2.2 Removing And Installing The Battery Pack  
Note: TURN OFF THE HAND-HELD BEFORE REMOVING THE BATTERY  
PACK. If you do not turn the hand-held off before removing the battery, it  
may be necessary to reboot the unit. Any active sessions may be lost.  
Removing The Battery Pack  
If your unit is equipped with a handstrap, unhook it from the base of  
the battery.  
Press down the release tab at the top of the battery, and slide the battery out.  
Installing The Battery Pack  
To install the battery pack:  
Slide the battery pack with the contoured plastic facing you into the  
7530 G2. Click the battery into place.  
the handstrap into the slot at the base of the battery.  
3.2.3 Battery Chargers  
Important: FOR DETAILED INFORMATION about chargers and docking  
stations, refer to Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
beginning on page 213. For battery safety, refer to “Lithium-Ion  
Battery Safety Precautions” on page XII.  
All batteries must be charged before use. The battery can be charged with a variety  
of chargers. These include:  
32  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
The Keyboard  
6-Unit Gang Charger (Model #HU3006) – charges up to six Lithium-Ion  
batteries at one time.  
Portable Docking Module (Model #HU4001 or HU1005 and HU3220) –  
charges the 7530 G2 battery (with the battery installed in the unit).  
Combo Charger (Model #HU3002) – a desktop charger that charges the  
internal battery along with a spare battery pack.  
Combo Docking Station (Model #HU4002) – operates as both a charger  
and a docking station. Operating as a charger, both the battery installed in  
the computer and a spare battery can be charged simultaneously.  
Quad Docking Station (Model #HU4004) – can charge the battery of up to  
four hand-helds inserted in the docking station while transferring data  
through an Ethernet connection.  
Powered Cradle (Model # CV1010 and CV1030) – can charge the 7530 G2  
with the battery installed in the hand-held.  
It can take from 1.5 to 4 hours to charge a battery. The unit’s intelligent charging  
system protects the battery from over-charging by terminating the charge process  
when the battery is at maximum capacity.  
for additional information about the battery.  
Important: To avoid damaging the battery, chargers will not begin the charge  
process until the battery temperature is between 0° C (32° F) and  
39° C (102° F). If the battery is too hot or cold, the battery status  
LED flashes yellow and the charge is suspended. Refer to  
Table 3.1, “Charge LEDs” on page 44 for details.  
3.3 The Keyboard  
The 7530 G2 offers two types of keyboard layouts – a 63-key and a 37-key  
keyboard. Most of the keys on these keyboards operate much like a desktop  
computer. Where a key or key function is not consistent with the PC keyboard, the  
differences are noted.  
The [BLUE] and [ORANGE] modifier keys provide access to additional keys and  
system functions. These functions are colour coded in orange and blue print above  
the keyboard keys.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
Modifier Keys  
3.3.1 Modifier Keys  
The [SHIFT], [CTRL], [ALT], [BLUE] and [ORANGE] keys are modifier keys.  
Pressing a modifier key changes the function of the next key pressed. For example,  
on a 63-key keyboard, a square bracket is printed in orange print above the [4] key.  
Pressing the [ORANGE] key followed by the [4] key displays a square bracket  
rather than the number 4.  
The [SHIFT], [CTRL] and [ALT] keys operate much like a desktop keyboard except  
that they are not chorded (two keys held down simultaneously). The modifier key  
must be pressed first followed by the key whose function you want modified.  
3.3.1.1 Activating Modifier Keys  
When a modifier key is not locked ‘on’, it is displayed in lowercase letters in the  
taskbar at the bottom of the hand-held screen. For example, if the [CTRL] key is  
pressed, ctrl key is displayed at the bottom of the unit screen in lowercase letters.  
When the next key is pressed, the modifier key becomes inactive and is cleared from  
the taskbar.  
3.3.1.2 Locking Modifier Keys  
Note: The locking function of the modifier keys can be set up so that pressing  
one of these keys once will lock the key ‘on’. They can also be set up so  
that they must be pressed twice to be locked ‘on’. Refer to “Keyboard One  
Shot Modes” on page 93 for details.  
When a modifier key is ‘locked’ on, it is displayed in uppercase letters in the  
taskbar. For example, if the [BLUE] key is locked on – it is displayed as BLUE KEY in  
the taskbar at the bottom of the screen.  
The locked modifier key will remain active until it is pressed again to unlock or turn  
it off. Once a modifier key is unlocked, the uppercase representation in the taskbar  
is cleared.  
3.3.2 The Keys  
The [SHIFT] Key  
The [SHIFT] key is used to display uppercase alpha characters and provide access to  
the symbols above the numeric keys.  
34  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
The Keys  
The Arrow Keys  
The Arrow keys move the cursor around the screen in the direction of the arrow –  
up, down, left and right. The cursor is the flashing box or underline character that  
indicates where the next character you type will appear.  
The [BKSP/DEL] Key  
The [BKSP] key (sometimes referred to as destructive backspace) moves the cursor  
one character to the left, erasing the incorrectly entered key stroke.  
The [DEL] key ([BLUE] [BKSP]) erases the character at the cursor position.  
The [CTRL] And [ALT] Key  
The [CTRL] and [ALT] keys modify the function of the next key pressed and are  
application dependent.  
The [TAB] Key  
Typically, the [TAB] key moves the cursor to the next field to the right or  
downward.  
The [ESC] Key  
Generally, this key is used as a keyboard shortcut to close the current menu, dialog  
box or activity and return to the previous one.  
The [SPACE] Key  
Pressing this key inserts a blank space between characters. In a Windows dialog  
box, pressing the [SPACE] key enables or disables a checkbox.  
The [SCAN] Key  
Pressing the [SCAN] key – the yellow key with the star-burst scan symbol on it –  
activates the scanner beam while pressed. For units that do not have internal  
scanners, this key can be remapped for another use.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
Function And Macro Keys  
3.3.3 Function And Macro Keys  
In addition to the standard keyboard functions (see “The Keyboard” on page 33), the  
7530 G2 supports function keys and macro keys.  
3.3.3.1 Function Keys  
63-Key Keyboard Function Keys  
The 63-key keyboard is equipped with thirty function keys. Function keys [F1] to  
[F10] are located in the top two rows of the keyboard and are directly accessible – a  
key combination is not required. Function keys [F11] to [F30] are colour coded in  
blue print above the alpha keys and are accessed using a key combination – [BLUE]  
followed by the appropriate alpha key.  
To access function keys [F11] to [F30]:  
Press the [BLUE] key followed by the alpha key to which the  
function key you want to use is mapped. For example:  
To access function key [F11], press [BLUE] [C].  
To access function key [F12], press [BLUE] [D], and so on.  
37-Key Keyboard Function Keys  
The 37-key keyboard is equipped with twenty function keys. Function keys [F1] to  
[F4] are located across the top of the keyboard and function keys [F5] to [F10] are  
located at the bottom of the keyboard.  
Additional function keys – [F11] to [F20] – are colour coded in orange print above  
function keys [F1] to [F10].  
To access function keys [F11] to [F20]:  
Press the [ORANGE] key followed by the appropriate function key.  
For example:  
To access function key [F11], press the [ORANGE] key followed  
by [F1].  
To access function key [F12], press [ORANGE] followed by [F2],  
and so on.  
36  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
Macro Keys  
3.3.3.2 Macro Keys  
Important:  
Refer to “Keyboard Macro Keys” on page 94 for details about  
creating macros.  
7530 G2 hand-helds are equipped with a series of macro keys that can be  
programmed to replace frequently used keystrokes, along with the function of  
executable keys like the [ENTER] key, the [BKSP] key, any function key and arrow  
key, and so on.  
63-Key Keyboard Macro Keys  
63-key (alphanumeric) keyboards have twelve macro keys – [M1] to [M12]. These  
keys are colour coded in orange print above alpha keys [O] to [Z].  
To access a macro key:  
Press the [ORANGE] key followed by the appropriate alpha key from  
O to Z. For example:  
To access macro key [M1], press [ORANGE] [O].  
To access macro key [M2], press [ORANGE] [P], and so on.  
37-Key Keyboard Macro Keys  
37- key (numeric) keyboards are equipped with six macro keys – [M1] to [M6].  
Macro keys [M1] to [M2] are directly accessible in the bottom row of the keyboard  
– a key combination is not required.  
Macro keys [M3] and [M4] are colour coded in orange print above macro keys [M1]  
and [M2].  
To access [M3], press the [ORANGE] key followed by [M1]  
To access [M4], press [ORANGE] [M2].  
Macro keys [M5] to [M6] are colour coded in blue print above macro keys [M1]  
and [M2].  
To access [M5], press the [BLUE] key followed by [M1].  
To access [M6], press [BLUE] [M2].  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
Alphanumeric Keyboard – 63-Key  
3.3.4 Alphanumeric Keyboard – 63-Key  
On 63-key, alphanumeric keyboards, all alphabetic and numeric keys are directly  
accessible from the keyboard; a key combination is not required.  
Function keys [F1] through [F24] can be used with the CE operating system or  
another application. The additional function keys, [F25] through [F30] along with  
the macro keys, are not used as part of the Windows CE operating system.  
All function keys and macro keys can be custom defined for each application. The  
TekTerm application utilizes these keys (for detailed information, see the TekTerm  
Software User Manual, PN 8000073). Refer to “Function And Macro Keys” on  
page 36 for details about accessing function keys [F25] to [F30].  
3.3.5 Numeric Keyboard – 37-Key  
On 37-key 7530 G2s, all alpha characters are printed on the unit plastic in orange  
typeface above the numeric keys. To access an alpha character, you must first press  
the [ORANGE] key and then press the numeric key above which the alpha character  
you want to type is printed.  
Because the alpha keys on these keyboards are laid out much like the letters on a  
telephone – generally in groups of three letters per numeric key – you need to take a  
few extra steps to access the alphabetic characters. The examples in this section help  
illustrate how to access alpha characters.  
Choosing A Single Alpha Character  
Note: As you press alpha keys, each is displayed in the left-hand corner of the  
taskbar to make it easier to determine which letter is currently active.  
Alpha key  
representation.  
38  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
Numeric Keyboard – 37-Key  
The examples below illustrate how to access A, B and C, all of which are printed in  
orange characters above the numeric key, [2].  
To choose the letter ‘a’:  
Press the [ORANGE] key, and press the numeric key [2].  
To choose the letter ‘b’:  
Lock the [ORANGE] key on, and press [2] twice.  
Press the [ORANGE] key again to unlock it.  
To choose the letter ‘c’:  
Lock the [ORANGE] key on.  
Press [2] three times.  
Press the [ORANGE] key again to unlock it.  
Creating Uppercase Letters  
To display a capital letter:  
Press the [ORANGE] key and then the [SHIFT] key before typing the  
alpha character.  
Choosing More Than One Alpha Character From The Same Key  
If you need to choose more than one alpha character from a single key, you’ll need  
to press the ‘Accept’ key between alpha selections. The ‘Accept’ key is presented as  
an arrow [⇒] symbol above the [0] (zero) key. Pressing this key signals the 7530 G2  
to display the alpha character you’ve chosen and await the next selection from the  
same key.  
Note: Remember that as you choose alpha keys, each is displayed in the  
left-hand corner of the taskbar to make it easier to determine which letter  
is currently chosen.  
For example, suppose you want to type the letters ‘a’, ‘b’ and ‘c’. These letters are  
all accessible from the numeric key, [2].  
To type the letter ‘a’:  
Lock the [ORANGE] key ‘on’, and then press the numeric key, [2].  
Press the ‘Accept’ key [] (zero key) to indicate that the letter ‘a’ should  
be accepted and that another letter from the same key will be chosen.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
The Keypad Backlight  
To type the letter ‘b’:  
Press the [2] key twice.  
Press [] to accept the letter ‘b’.  
To type the letter ‘c’:  
Press the [2] key three times.  
When you have completed your alpha selections from this key, you can do one of the  
following:  
If you want to choose additional alpha characters from another key(s),  
leave the [ORANGE] key locked ‘on’, and press the next numeric key that  
supports the alpha character you require, or  
If you do not want to choose any additional alpha characters, unlock the  
[ORANGE] key, and end alpha selection.  
Choosing Multiple Alpha Characters From A Range Of Keys  
If you plan on choosing alpha characters from a number of different keys, you are  
not required to press the ‘Accept’ [] key after each alpha selection. The [] key  
is only required when you are choosing more than one alpha character from the  
same key – e.g., ‘a’, ‘b’ and ‘c’ from the [2] key.  
Suppose you want to type the letters ‘a’, ‘d’ and ‘g’. These alpha characters are  
accessed from the numeric keys [2], [3] and [4].  
With the [ORANGE] key locked ‘on’, press [2] to type the letter ‘a’.  
Press [3] to type ‘d’, and press [4] to type the letter ‘g’.  
To end alpha selection, unlock the [ORANGE] key.  
3.3.6 The Keypad Backlight  
Note: This option may be restricted to supervisory use only.  
The intensity of the keypad backlight and the conditions under which this  
backlight is activated can be tailored in the Keyboard Properties dialog box in  
the Control Panel.  
Note: Refer to “Keyboard Backlight” on page 92 for details about this option.  
40  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
The Display  
3.4 The Display  
7530 G2s are equipped with display backlighting to improve character visibility in  
low light conditions. The backlight switches on when a key is pressed and the  
ambient light is below the set threshold. A light sensor on the front of the hand-held  
determines the ambient light level. On some displays, the contrast can also be  
adjusted to further improve character visibility.  
3.4.1 Adjusting The Display Backlight  
The behaviour of the display backlight can be specified in the Display Properties  
dialog box in the Control Panel.  
Note: Refer to “Display Backlight” on page 88 for details about the Display  
Properties dialog box.  
3.4.2 Adjusting The Contrast  
Note: In addition to the manual adjustments described in this section, the dis-  
play contrast can also be adjusted using the Control Panel. Refer to “Dis-  
play Contrast” on page 87 for details about this dialog box.  
The display contrast can be adjusted from the unit keyboard using the [BLUE] key  
and function keys [F1] and [F2]. Pressing [F1]  
darkens the display, and  
pressing [F2] lightens the display. Keep in mind that adjusting the contrast on a  
colour display is much less pronounced than on a monochrome display.  
To adjust the display contrast:  
Lock the [BLUE] key on, and then press [F1] to darken the display or [F2]  
to lighten the display.  
Once you’ve successfully adjusted the display contrast, remember to press  
the [BLUE] key again to unlock or turn it ‘off’.  
Note: Contrast settings are optimized for the maximum readability. However, if  
the display jitters or flickers, consider adjusting the contrast at power up.  
3.4.3 Calibrating The Touchscreen  
If your 7530 G2 touchscreen has never been calibrated, or if you find that the stylus  
pointer is not accurate when you tap on an item, use the Stylus Properties dialog  
box in the Control Panel to recalibrate the screen.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
Calibrating The Touchscreen  
In the Control Panel, tap on the Stylus icon to display the Stylus  
Properties window.  
Figure 3.2 Stylus Icon  
Select the Calibration tab, and then choose the Recalibrate button.  
Follow the directions on the calibration screen to calibrate the screen.  
42  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
7530 G2 Indicators  
3.5 7530 G2 Indicators  
7530 G2s use LEDs (Light Emitting Diode), onscreen messages and audio tones as  
indicators.  
3.5.1 LEDs  
Hand-helds are equipped with four tri-coloured LEDs. This section outlines what  
these LEDs indicate.  
Important: If an LED is illuminated in red, the operator should be cautious  
as this generally indicates an abnormal operating condition or  
active laser emission.  
User Application LED  
Charge LED  
Radio Traffic LED  
Scanner LED  
Figure 3.3 Keyboard LEDs  
3.5.1.1 Charge LED  
The lower-right LED is reserved for internal charger/power status. This indicator is  
active even when the hand-held is inserted in a docking station (and in suspend  
mode) so that the charge status of the battery can be detected easily.  
Function  
External power not available.  
Charge LED Behaviour  
LED off.  
Fully charged to within 95% of charge  
capacity.  
LED displays solid green colour.  
LED flashes slow green.  
Quick charge successfully completed to  
within 75% of charge capacity.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
Radio Traffic LED  
Function  
Charge in progress.  
Charge LED Behaviour  
LED displays solid yellow colour.  
Cell temperature out of range for charge. LED flashes yellow.  
Unable to charge battery.  
Charge circuit failure.*  
LED displays solid red colour.  
LED flashes fast red.*  
Table 3.1 Charge LEDs  
* If the charge fails, refer to the charger troubleshooting sections in ‘Chapter 6:  
Peripheral Devices & Accessories’ beginning on page 213 for helpful details.  
3.5.1.2 Radio Traffic LED  
The upper-left LED on your unit flashes either yellow or green to indicate when the  
radio transmits and receives data.  
Note: Keep in mind that while the standard 802.11 radio supports the trans-  
mit/receive LED, not all radios support this function.  
Function  
Radio Transmit  
Radio Receive  
Radio Traffic LED Behaviour  
LED flashes yellow.  
LED flashes green.  
Table 3.2 Transmit and Receive LEDs  
3.5.1.3 Scan LED  
Successful scans are indicated in two ways – with a scan LED and with an  
audio tone.  
Function  
Scan LED Behaviour  
LED displays solid red during scan.  
LED displays solid green after decode.  
Off when scan ended.  
Scan in progress  
Successful scan  
Unsuccessful scan  
LED flashes red.  
Table 3.3 Scan LED  
3.5.1.4 User Application LED  
This indicator is available for user-loaded custom Windows CE applications. Your  
supervisor can describe how this LED behaves with your application. Neither  
Windows CE nor Open Tekterm V2.0 use this LED.  
44  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
Onscreen Indicators  
3.5.2 Onscreen Indicators  
The taskbar at the bottom of the screen displays a variety of system status indicators.  
Figure 3.4 Taskbar  
The taskbar changes dynamically, and only those icons that are applicable are  
displayed. For example, if a radio is not installed in your 7530 G2, the radio signal  
icon is not displayed in the taskbar.  
Windows® Start Button  
If you have a touchscreen, you can display the Start Menu by tapping on the Windows  
Start button in the taskbar.  
Modifier Key Indicators  
[SHIFT], [CTRL], [ALT], [BLUE] and [ORANGE] are modifier keys that when  
pressed, are displayed in the taskbar to indicate that they are active. If a modifier key  
is locked ‘on’, it is displayed in uppercase characters. For example, if the [BLUE]  
key is locked on, it is displayed as BLUE KEY in the taskbar. A locked modifier key  
remains active until it is pressed again to unlock or turn it off.  
If a modifier key has been pressed but is not locked on, it is displayed in the taskbar  
in lowercase characters – for example, blue key. It will remain active only until the next  
key is pressed at which point, the modifier key is turned off.  
Note: The locking function of the modifier keys can be set up so that pressing  
one of these keys once will lock the key ‘on’. They can also be set up so  
that they must be pressed twice to be locked ‘on’. Refer to “Keyboard One  
Shot Modes” on page 93 for details.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
Onscreen Indicators  
Battery Gauge  
The battery shaped icon displayed in the taskbar provides a visual indication of the  
remaining battery power. The icon acts as a meter that is either full, at three-quarter  
level, half, quarter level or empty.  
When the battery level is low – approximately 15 minutes from empty – a warning  
window pops up. When the battery power is completely depleted, a final warning  
window indicates that the 7530 G2 will be powered down.  
If the 7530 G2 is using external AC power, an AC icon is displayed in the taskbar.  
Full  
75%  
50%  
25%  
Empty  
AC Connection  
Battery Charge  
The battery charge icon is displayed in the taskbar when the hand-held battery is  
being charged.  
802.11 Radio Signal Quality  
Increasing radio signal quality is represented by longer, filled bars within this icon.  
Good  
Reception  
Weak  
Reception  
No Radio  
Link  
Narrow Band Radio Signal Quality  
Increasing radio signal quality is represented by vertical bars within this icon.  
Good  
Reception  
Weak  
Reception  
No Radio  
Link  
46  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
Audio Indicators  
Tethered Devices  
When a peripheral is attached to the tether port and activated, an associated icon  
appears in the taskbar.  
Scanner USB Device  
RFID  
Serial Device  
Docking Device  
When a hand-held is inserted in a docking station, charger or cradle, an associated  
icon appears in the taskbar.  
Gang Charger, Combo Charger & Quad Docking Station Power Cradle  
Combo Docking Station  
Portable Docking  
Module (PDM)  
Bluetooth Radio  
This icon represents the Bluetooth radio installed in your unit.  
Security Level  
Security levels can be set to limit user access. In addition, applications can be  
restricted to prevent inadvertent changes.  
3.5.3 Audio Indicators  
The beeper provides a variety of sounds and can be configured to emit a sound when  
a key is pressed, a keyboard character is rejected, scan input is accepted or rejected,  
an operator’s entry does not match in a match field or the battery is low. The volume  
function keys are located in the top row of the keyboard. The increase volume key is  
labelled with a plus symbol  
with a minus symbol  
and the decrease volume function key is labelled  
.
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
Adjusting The Beeper Volume  
3.5.3.1 Adjusting The Beeper Volume  
On 63-key keyboards, the volume function keys are accessed by pressing [BLUE]  
[F5] and [F6].  
On 37-key keyboards, the volume function keys are accessed by pressing [BLUE]  
[F3] and [F4].  
To adjust the beeper volume:  
Lock the [BLUE] key ‘on’ and then, press the increase volume function key  
or the decrease volume function key until the volume meets  
your requirements.  
Remember to unlock the [BLUE] key when you’ve completed the volume  
adjustment.  
3.6 Internal Scanners  
Important: For detailed scanner specifications and decode zone tables, refer  
to “Internal Scanner Specifications” beginning on page 240.  
7530 G2s support a wide range of scanner options to address a variety of user applica-  
tion requirements. The scanner installed in your unit can be configured using the  
Scanner Settings dialog box in the Control Panel (see page 143) and the Manage  
Triggers application (see page page 109). External, non-decoded scanners are also  
configured through the Control Panel.  
However, external decoded scanners must be configured by scanning special configura-  
tion bar codes. In these cases, the scanner manufacturer provides programming  
manuals for configuration purposes.  
For Symbol decoded scanners, refer to the LS3408 programming guide.  
For PowerScan (PSC) decoded scanners, refer to the Powerscan Programing  
Guide (PSC).  
Scanner types include:  
Advanced Long Range: reads very large 1D bar codes (60 mil+) at very  
long distances (up to 14m).  
Long Range: reads large 1D bar codes (55 mil) at long distances (up to 3m).  
High Performance: reads1D linear bar codes (5 - 55 mil) at medium dis-  
tances (up to 1m).  
Extended Range: reads regular 1D bar codes (5 - 55mil) at short to medium  
distances (1m), as well as large 1D bar codes (e.g. 55 mil) at long distances.  
48  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
Scanning Techniques  
RFID: The RD7950 UHF RFID Reader is an EPC-compliant RFID reader  
which can be integrated with laser bar code scanning or imaging (for  
future release).  
Fuzzy Logic: reads damaged or low contrast regular 1D bar codes  
(5 - 55mil) at medium distances (up to 1m).  
PDF Raster Laser: reads 2D PDF bar codes or regular 1D bar codes at short  
to medium distances.  
2D Imager: reads regular 1D and all 2D bar codes at short to medium distances.  
1D Imager: reads regular 1D and PDF417 bar codes at short to  
medium distances.  
It is critical that you review the warnings listed under “Warning to Users” beginning  
on page XI (at the beginning of this manual) before using any of the scanners  
described in this chapter. “Scanning Techniques” outlines the mechanics of a  
successful scan. In addition, review “Scan LED Indicators” on page 50 to better  
understand how to interpret whether or not a bar code has been successfully scanned.  
Finally, “Troubleshooting” on page 50 provides some helpful suggestions should the  
scan fail.  
3.6.1 Scanning Techniques  
Note: The scanning techniques described here apply to internal and  
external scanners.  
Hold the scanner at an angle. Do not hold it perpendicular to the bar code.  
Do not hold the scanner directly over the bar code. In this position, light  
can reflect back into the scanner’s exit window and prevent a successful  
decode.  
Scan the entire bar code. If you are using a 1D or 2D scanner, make certain  
that the scan beam crosses every bar and space on the bar code, including  
the margins on either end of the symbol.  
If you are using a 2D imaging scanner, make certain the red, oval-shaped  
framing mark is centered within the bar code you want to scan.  
When using imaging scanners, do not move the scanner while decoding the  
bar code. Movement blurs the image.  
Hold the scanner farther away for larger bar codes.  
Hold the scanner closer for bar codes with bars that are close together.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
Scan LED Indicators  
3.6.2 Scan LED Indicators  
The scanner LED (the lower-left LED) indicates whether or not your scan is  
successful. The LED behaves as follows:  
Scan In Progress: scan LED displays solid red colour.  
Successful Scan: scan LED displays solid green colour and turns off when  
the scan is ended.  
Unsuccessful scan: scan LED flashes red.  
A bar code icon appears on the screen during a scan. While the scanner beam  
is active, the onscreen message states – SCANNING. If the scan is successful,  
the bar code data is displayed on the screen until the scan button (or pistol trigger)  
is released.  
3.6.3 Troubleshooting  
If the scanner is not working, investigate the following:  
Is the unit on?  
Check that the bar code symbology being scanned is enabled for the  
hand-held you are using. Check any other parameters that affect the scan-  
ning procedure or the bar code.  
Check the bar code to make sure it is not damaged. Try scanning a different  
bar code to verify that the problem is not with the bar code.  
Check that the bar code is within the proper range.  
Does the hand-held display the warning without scanning? This suggests a  
hardware problem in the hand-held.  
Is the laser beam scanning across the bar code?  
Once the scan beam has stopped, check the scanner window for  
dirt or fogging.  
3.6.4 Operating One Dimensional (1D) Internal Laser Scanners  
Turn the hand-held on. Wait until the unit has booted up completely.  
Important: If an aiming dot is available on the installed scanner, the dot will  
be enabled for a configurable time period (including off), after  
which normal scanning begins. Refer to “Dot Time (msec)” on  
page 146 for details.  
50  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
Operating Internal PDF Laser Scanners  
Double-clicking the trigger will override the aiming delay and  
initiate an immediate scan. Note that the aiming dot is standard  
on long-range and high visibility internal scanners.  
Aim at the bar code and press the scan key or the trigger. A scan beam and a  
warning indicator appear until a successful decode is achieved or six  
seconds have elapsed.  
3.6.5 Operating Internal PDF Laser Scanners  
This scanner decodes PDF417 two-dimensional bar codes.  
Turn the hand-held on. Wait until the unit has booted up completely.  
Aim at the bar code and press the scan key or the trigger. The beam expands  
into a rectangle covering the bar code to properly scan it. The scan beam  
and a warning indicator are visible until a successful decode is achieved or  
three seconds have elapsed.  
3.6.6 Operating Internal Two Dimensional (2D) Imager Scanners  
An imager scanner takes a snap shot of a single bar code or multiple bar codes (at  
one time). It can find a bar code regardless of its orientation – that is, even a bar  
code printed at a 45 degree angle to the hand-held will be decoded successfully.  
Note: When scanning multiple bar codes, ensure that all of the desired bar  
codes are within the field of view of the scanner. It is possible that even  
when all bar codes are within the field of view, not all of them will be  
decoded. Only successfully decoded bar codes are passed to the applica-  
tion program. The application program then issues a warning, asking that  
you scan the missing bar codes.  
When scanning a single bar code, ensure that only the desired bar code is  
within the field of view of the scanner.  
Because imager scanners generally have a shorter depth of field than laser scanners,  
some practise may be required to find the optimal distance from the types of bar  
codes being scanned. Although the imager includes illumination LEDs, ambient  
light will help the imager decode the bar codes, especially if the bar code is far from  
the hand-held.  
Important: Keep in mind that the imager scanner is a camera, and the LED  
illumination is a flash. Glare can be an issue on reflective media  
such as plastic coated bar codes, just as glare is an issue for pho-  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
Connecting & Disconnecting Tethered Peripherals  
tographers. When pointing at a shiny surface, either shift the bar  
code to the side or top, or angle the bar code so that the glare  
reflects away from the imager scanner.  
Most imagers take several ‘snap shots’ of the bar code in order to  
decode it. It is normal for the LEDs to flash two or three times. Hold  
the unit steady between flashes to improve decode performance.  
Turn the hand-held computer on. Wait until the unit has booted  
up completely.  
Aim at the bar code and press the scan key or the trigger.  
When the scan button or trigger is pressed, a red, oval shaped light (the  
framing marker) is displayed. Centre the framing marker in the field –  
either in the centre of the bar code you want to scan or in the centre of the  
area in which multiple bar codes are to be scanned. Hold the scan trigger or  
button until a successful or failed scan result is obtained.  
Illumination LEDs flashes (typically several times) and a picture of the bar code(s)  
is taken.  
3.7 Connecting & Disconnecting Tethered Peripherals  
Tethered peripherals such as scanners and printers connect to the hand-held  
computer with a quick release, circular connector. When a peripheral is connected to  
the hand-held, the unit detects the peripheral and loads the necessary drivers for it.  
An icon in the taskbar at the bottom of the screen provides a visual representation of  
the peripheral and indicates that it is ready for operation.  
To attach the peripheral to the round, tether port on the side of the unit:  
Insert the barrel of the plug into the tether port and rotate slowly until  
it clicks into place. The red dot on the port and on the connector should  
be aligned.  
52  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
Monitoring The Battery And Maximizing Run Time  
Tether Shell  
To remove the peripheral:  
Grasp the shell of the plug, and pull it back gently to unlock and release the  
connector.  
Important: Never attempt to disconnect a peripheral by pulling the cable by  
the wire. The connector is locked into place and can only be  
unlocked and removed by pulling back the plug shell.  
3.8 Monitoring The Battery And Maximizing Run Time  
Under normal operating conditions, fully charged batteries last for 9 hours. As  
Lithium-Ion batteries age, their capacity decreases gradually, and they are generally  
considered depleted after approximately 2 years of use (less than 60% of original  
capacity remaining). Keep in mind however that heavy usage or operating the 7530  
G2 at temperature extremes will shorten the battery life.  
Lithium-Ion batteries do not require conditioning cycles and the 7530 G2 battery system  
(including chargers) requires no user interaction to maintain peak performance.  
To maximize the run time of your batteries, consider the following:  
The display backlight is the largest drain on the battery. Try to keep its  
brightness as low as possible.  
Depending on the ambient light at your site, consider turning off the  
keypad backlight.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
Storing Batteries  
The hand-held is ‘event’ driven – that is, when the unit is not in use, it  
reverts to sleep mode (even when it appears to be running), saving battery  
power. Events include a key press, touchscreen taps and scan triggers.  
Power consumption is reduced if you avoid unnecessary events, and allow  
the unit to sleep as much as possible.  
The hand-held battery is a ‘smart battery’ with built-in intelligence. The  
taskbar battery icon is a linear gauge used to estimate the remaining run  
time of the battery. It is important to note that the battery capacity icon dis-  
plays quarter percentages of nominal capacity (the capacity of a new bat-  
tery). An aged battery, even when fully charged, shows somewhat less  
capacity than nominal.  
Double-tapping on the battery icon displays a dialog box that provides  
detailed information about the battery status and performance. If the  
remaining capacity indication seems inaccurate, the battery may need recal-  
ibration. Recalibration requires that the battery be fully charged, discharged  
and then charged again before use. If the battery is fully discharged and  
charged on a regular basis, recalibration should not be necessary.  
When the hand-held is switched off, it goes into a low-power, suspend state  
but continues to draw a small amount of power from the battery. This  
should not be an issue unless the unit is left in suspend state for more than a  
week – in this case, the battery should be removed.  
Batteries left unused for durations of more than one or two months should  
be fully charged, discharged (operated in the hand held until the low battery  
warning appears), and then charged again before use. This recalibrates the  
gas gauge and allows the internal electronics to determine the actual capac-  
ity of the battery.  
3.8.1 Storing Batteries  
Long term battery storage is not recommended. If storage is necessary:  
Always try to use a ‘first-in first-out’ approach to minimize storage time.  
Lithium-Ion batteries age much faster at elevated temperatures. Store bat-  
teries at temperatures between 0° C and 20°C.  
Always charge batteries to 40 to 60% before storing them. Batteries can be  
damaged by an over-discharge phenomenon that occurs when an empty  
battery is stored for a long period of time such that the cell voltage drops  
below a lower limit.  
54  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
Monitoring The Network Connection  
To minimize storage degradation, recharge stored batteries to 40 to 60%  
every 4 or 6 months to prevent over-discharge damage.  
A ‘never used’ Li-Ion battery that has been stored for 3 years may have  
limited or no useful life remaining once put into service. Think of batteries  
as perishable goods.  
3.9 Monitoring The Network Connection  
If your hand-held is equipped with a wireless LAN radio, it will typically associate  
with the nearest access point. The radio signal quality meter in the taskbar indicates  
the relative strength of the communication link.  
Tap on the Radio icon in the taskbar to display the Wireless Statistics  
dialog box.  
To access the radio signal icon using the keyboard:  
Press [BLUE] [0] to display the Start Menu.  
Highlight Shortcuts and then choose System Tray from the sub-menu.  
Use the [LEFT] and [RIGHT] arrow keys to highlight the radio signal icon  
in the taskbar.  
Press [ENTER] to display the Wireless Statistics dialog box.  
Note: Moving in and out of the radio coverage area can have varying effects on  
a network session. At times, you may need to renew your connection by  
logging in again.  
3.10 Uploading Data In A Docking Station  
The Combo Docking and Quad Docking peripherals allow your hand-held to link to  
an Ethernet network. They are typically used to upload transaction data to a server  
computer when a radio link is not available. When a 7530 G2 is properly inserted in  
a docking station, a dock icon is displayed in the taskbar at the bottom of the unit  
screen. The hand-held also detects the presence of the Ethernet network. Review the  
documentation provided with the user application installed in your 7530 G2 before  
preforming data uploads.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 3: Getting To Know Your 7530 G2  
General Maintenance  
3.11 General Maintenance  
3.11.1 Caring For The Touchscreen  
The touchscreen is covered with a thin, flexible polyester plastic sheet with a  
conductive coating on the inside. The polyester can be permanently damaged  
by harsh chemicals and is susceptible to abrasions and scratches. Using sharp  
objects on the touchscreen can scratch or cut the plastic, or crack the internal  
conductive coating.  
The chemicals listed below must not come into contact with the touchscreen:  
mustard, ketchup  
sodium hydroxide,  
concentrated caustic solutions,  
benzyl alcohol, and  
concentrated acids.  
If the touchscreen is used in harsh environments, consider applying a disposable  
screen protector (PN HU6110). These covers reduce the clarity of the display  
slightly but will dramatically extend the useful life of the touchscreen. When they  
become scratched and abraded, they are easily removed and replaced.  
3.11.2 Cleaning The 7530 G2  
Important: Do not immerse the unit in water. Dampen a soft cloth with mild  
detergent to wipe the unit clean.  
Use only mild detergent or soapy water to clean the hand-held unit.  
Avoid abrasive cleaners, solvents or strong chemicals for cleaning. The  
7530 G2 has a plastic case that is susceptible to harsh chemicals. The plastic  
is partially soluble in oils, mineral spirits and gasoline. The plastic slowly  
decomposes in strong alkaline solutions.  
To clean ink marks from the keypad and touchscreen, use isopropyl alcohol.  
56  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
4.1.2 Navigating Using The Keyboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59  
4.4.2.3 Configuring Security. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67  
4.4.3 Programs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68  
4.4.4 Shortcuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69  
4.4.5 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71  
4.4.6 Run . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72  
4.4.7 Shutdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72  
4.5 Using A Dialog Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4: Working With Windows CE  
Navigating In Windows CE And Applications  
4.1 Navigating In Windows CE And Applications  
Graphic user interfaces like Windows CE for portable devices and desktop  
Windows (2000, XP, etc.) utilize ‘point and click’ navigation. An equivalent  
keyboard shortcut is also available for every ‘point and click’ action.  
Windows CE supports the same ‘point and click’ user interface and keyboard  
shortcuts as desktop Windows with one difference – the ‘point and click’ action is  
accomplished using a touchscreen rather than a mouse. Actions can be performed  
using any combination of keyboard shortcuts or touchscreen tapping.  
Note: The security level must be set to ‘Supervisor’ in order to access many of  
the items discussed in this section.  
4.1.1 Navigating Using A Touchscreen And Stylus  
Note: If the touchscreen is not registering your screen taps accurately, the  
touchscreen may need recalibration. Refer to “Calibrating The Touch-  
screen” on page 41.  
A touchscreen is standard for all 7530 G2s. Each unit is equipped with a stylus – a  
pointing tool that looks like a pen – stored in a slot at the top of the unit. The stylus  
is used to select objects on the touchscreen.  
Note: To prevent damage to the touchscreen, use only the stylus (pen)  
supplied with your 7530 G2.  
To choose an icon, open a file, launch an applet or open a folder:  
Double-tap the stylus on the appropriate icon.  
4.1.2 Navigating Using The Keyboard  
If the touchscreen on your is disabled, you’ll need to use the keyboard to choose  
icons and navigate dialog boxes, display the desktop, and so on.  
Note: Keep in mind that if your 7530 G2 has already been fully configured and  
your application is automatically launched at startup, you will have little  
need for keyboard navigation.  
Operation  
Switch between active applications  
Open task manager  
Key or Key Combination  
[ALT] [TAB]  
[ALT] [ESC]  
Arrow keys  
Move the cursor  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 4: Working With Windows CE  
Working With Files, Folders And Programs  
Open file, folder or icon  
Exit & Save  
[ENTER]  
[ENTER]  
[ESC]  
Close/Exit & Do Not Save  
[TAB]  
To move cursor up [SHIFT] [TAB]  
To display the contents of the next ‘tab’ in  
a dialog box [CTRL] [TAB]  
Navigate Dialog Boxes  
Select Radio Button/Press Button  
Go to Start Menu  
[BLUE][0]  
Table 4.1 Keyboard Navigation  
Unlike a desktop computer, the 7530 G2 does not support key chording (pressing  
two keys at the same time). You must press one key followed by the next in  
sequence.  
Refer to “Working With Files, Folders And Programs” for additional details about  
keyboard navigation.  
4.2 Working With Files, Folders And Programs  
Folder  
File  
Program  
Double-tap on the appropriate icon – either a folder icon, a program icon or  
a file icon – to open or launch your selection.  
On a keyboard:  
Use the arrow keys to highlight the icon you want to open or launch.  
Press [ENTER].  
60  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 4: Working With Windows CE  
The Startup Desktop  
4.3 The Startup Desktop  
When the 7530 G2 boots up, the startup desktop (shell) is displayed. Any  
applications stored in the Startup folder start up immediately.  
Note: The startup folder is located in \Windows\StartUp and  
\Flash Disk\StartUp.  
Double-tap on the icon to open a window or, in the case of an application  
icon, launch an application.  
On the keyboard:  
Use the arrow keys to highlight the icon, and press [ENTER] to launch the  
highlighted icon.  
Note: If the arrow keys do not highlight the desktop icons, the desktop may not  
be selected. Press [BLUE] 0 (zero) to display the Start Menu, and select  
Desktop. Now the desktop will be “in focus” and the arrow keys will high-  
light the icons.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 4: Working With Windows CE  
The Desktop Icons  
The icons displayed in the startup desktop operate in much the same way as those  
displayed on any standard PC desktop that is running Windows.  
My Device  
Choosing this icon displays the contents of your 7530 G2 computer. If you’re not  
sure how to work with the files, folders and programs displayed, refer to “Working  
With Files, Folders And Programs” on page 60.  
Recycle Bin  
The Recycle Bin temporarily stores items that were deleted, allowing you to either  
permanently delete or restore these items.  
Internet Explorer  
Choosing this icon launches Internet Explorer – a standard Windows CE version.  
Keep in mind that your supervisor will need to set up access using the Internet  
Options and the Network and Dial-up Connections icons in the Control Panel.  
Remote Desktop Connection  
This option allows your 7530 G2 to communicate with a remote desktop PC. “Remote  
Desktop Connection” on page 81 provides a website with step-by-step instructions.  
4.3.2 The Taskbar  
The 7530 G2 is equipped with a taskbar at the bottom of the screen. It displays icons  
through which you can view the status of various elements of your unit such as  
62  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 4: Working With Windows CE  
Using The Taskbar  
battery capacity and radio signal quality. If the hand-held is attached to a charger,  
cradle, docking station or PDM, an associated icon is displayed. In addition, the  
taskbar displays the application(s) currently running on your unit and the security  
level assigned to your 7530 G2.  
The taskbar also displays active modifier keys – [SHIFT], [ALT], [CTRL], [BLUE]  
and [ORANGE]. Keys that have been locked “on” are displayed in uppercase  
letters. For example, if you lock the [CTRL] key “on”, it is displayed as CTRL KEY in  
the taskbar.  
4.3.2.1 Using The Taskbar  
Using the icons in the taskbar, you can either display the Control Panel dialog box  
associated with an icon, or you can view a tooltip. A tooltip provides the status of  
each icon.  
Tap and hold the stylus on an icon to display the icon’s tooltip. Double-tap  
on the icon to open the Control Panel dialog box associated with the icon.  
On the keyboard:  
Press [BLUE] [0] to display the Start Menu.  
Choose Shortcuts from the Start Menu, and then press the [RIGHT] arrow  
key to display the sub-menu.  
Choose System Tray in the sub-menu.  
Use the arrow keys to highlight the icon in the taskbar about which you’d  
like more information. As each icon is highlighted, a tooltip is displayed.  
To display the associated Control Panel dialog box, press [ENTER].  
4.3.2.2 Customizing The Taskbar  
To customize the taskbar so that it displays only those icons you require:  
In the Start Menu, tap on Settings>Taskbar.  
If you’re using the keyboard:  
Press [BLUE] [0] to display the Start Menu.  
Highlight the Settings option, highlight Taskbar in the sub-menu, and  
press [ENTER].  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 4: Working With Windows CE  
Customizing The Taskbar  
The Taskbar and Start Menu dialog box is displayed.  
Figure 4.1 Taskbar And Start Menu Settings  
Taskbar General Tab  
Tap on the items you want to display in the taskbar. The checkmark indi-  
cates items that will be displayed.  
If you’re using the keyboard:  
Highlight the options you want to activate, and press the [SPACE] key to  
select them.  
Taskbar Advanced Tab  
Tap on the Clear button to empty the Documents folder.  
To display Control Panel applets in menu form rather than in a window, tap  
in the checkbox next to Expand Control Panel.  
64  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4: Working With Windows CE  
The Start Menu  
Taskbar Security Tab  
If you check Disable hot keys, the Application from Start menu field becomes  
enabled. Use this field to enter the name of the application you want to run when the  
user presses the Menu hot key – [BLUE] [0].  
If you have disabled hot keys, hidden the Start Menu and have no application  
configured, the Menu hot key brings up the Security dialog box.  
4.4 The Start Menu  
Note: Some of the Start Menu items may be disabled based on the 7530 G2s  
current security settings.  
The Start Menu lists the operations you can access and work with. It is available  
from the startup desktop or from within any application.  
To display the menu:  
Press [BLUE] [0] (zero).  
Tap on the item in the menu with which you want to work.  
If you’re using a keyboard:  
Use the arrow keys to highlight a menu item, and press [ENTER], or  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 4: Working With Windows CE  
The Desktop  
If the menu item has an underlined character, type the underlined alpha  
character – for example, to display the Security dialog box, type the letter s.  
4.4.1 The Desktop  
Choosing the Desktop option from the Start Menu displays the 7530 G2 desktop.  
4.4.2 Security Settings  
Choosing the Security option from the Start Menu displays a dialog box in which  
you can define the access level for the 7530 G2 – Supervisor or User.  
Figure 4.2 Security Levels  
4.4.2.1 Assigning The Supervisor Security Level  
The security level is represented by an icon in the shape of a lock in the taskbar. The  
security levels define the options accessible to the operator in the Start Menu and  
the taskbar. By default, the security level is set to User, restricting access to only the  
most basic Start Menu items.  
To allow access to all the Start Menu and taskbar options:  
In the Security Level dialog box, tap on the radio button next to Supervisor.  
In the Password field, type the Supervisor level password.  
Tap on OK – you can now access all menu items in the Start Menu along  
with the icons in the taskbar.  
66  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Chapter 4: Working With Windows CE  
Changing A Password  
4.4.2.2 Changing A Password  
Note: Keep in mind that this is the same password as that assigned through the  
Password control panel applet.  
To assign a password, choose a security level, and enter the existing pass-  
word in the Password field.  
Tap on the Set Password button.  
A dialog box labelled Password Properties is displayed.  
Type the new password in the Password: text box  
In the Confirm Password: text box, retype the new password.  
4.4.2.3 Configuring Security  
In the Security Level dialog box (see Figure 4.2 on page 66):  
Tap on the Configure button.  
This dialog box also allows you to determine which security levels will have an  
associated icon displayed in the taskbar. By default, a security icon is not displayed  
for user-level security.  
Note: It is recommended that you enable ‘Allow Teklogix Security Level’ so that  
authorized Psion Teklogix service personnel can access your unit should  
it require maintenance.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 4: Working With Windows CE  
Programs  
4.4.3 Programs  
Tap on Programs to display a sub-menu of options.  
Figure 4.3 Program Sub-Menu  
This sub-menu allows you to choose ActiveSync and Command Prompt, and you  
can access the Internet Explorer, installed applications (e.g., Open Tekterm V2.0),  
Remote Desktop Connection or Windows Explorer.  
ActiveSync®  
ActiveSync is used to connect your PC to another device.  
Demo  
This folder contains the Demo Imager, Demo Scanner, Demo Signature and Demo  
Sound applications. Demo Imager is used for simple image-capturing purposes and  
for displaying bar code data and bar code statistics on the same screen with image  
data and information. Demo Scanner can be used to test how the hand-held reads  
and writes RFID tags. Demo Signature allows you to capture a signature written  
on the screen with your stylus and save it to a file. Demo Sound allows you to  
record sound.  
Command Prompt  
Command Prompt is used to access the DOS command prompt. At the prompt, you  
can type DOS commands such as dir to display all the directories in the drive.  
68  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 4: Working With Windows CE  
Shortcuts  
Internet Explorer  
The 7530 G2 is equipped with Microsoft Internet Explorer for Windows CE. You  
can access the Internet Options icon through the Start Menu under  
Settings>Control Panel or by double-tapping on the desktop icon My Device and  
then, double-tapping on the Control Panel icon.  
Windows Explorer  
The Windows Explorer installed on your 7530 G2 is consistent with all Windows  
CE devices. You can access this option from the Start Menu under Programs,  
Windows Explorer.  
Remote Desktop Connection  
Remote Desktop Connection is a 7530 G2 application used to connect to a Windows  
Terminal Server so that you can run a “session” on the Server machine using the  
7530 G2 (Windows CE device). “Remote Desktop Connection” on page 81  
provides a website with details about this option.  
4.4.4 Shortcuts  
Figure 4.4 Shortcuts Sub-Menu  
The System Tray  
If your touchscreen is disabled, you can use the System Tray option to access the  
icons in the taskbar at the bottom of the screen. The taskbar displays indicators such  
as a radio signal icon and the security level. These indicators are attached to dialog  
boxes that provide additional information.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 4: Working With Windows CE  
Shortcuts  
Press [BLUE] [0] to display the Start Menu.  
Using the arrow keys, highlight Shortcut>System Tray.  
When System Tray is chosen, the taskbar icons become accessible.  
Use the arrow keys to highlight an icon. As each icon is highlighted, a  
tooltip – a description of the status of the icon – is displayed.  
Press [ENTER] to display the Control Panel dialog box associated with  
the icon.  
Cycle Tasks  
When Cycle Tasks is selected (and the Task Manager is not open), you can cycle  
through active applications.  
To cycle through your active applications:  
Tap on Shortcuts>Cycle Tasks, or  
Press [ALT] [TAB].  
The Task Manager  
The Task Manager allows you to switch to another task or to end an active task. To  
display the task manager window:  
Tap on Shortcut>Task Manager, or  
Press [ALT] [ESC].  
70  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 4: Working With Windows CE  
Settings  
4.4.5 Settings  
The Settings sub-menu includes the following settings: Control Panel, Network  
and Dial-up Connections and Taskbar and Start Menu.  
Figure 4.5 Settings Sub-Menu  
Control Panel  
The Control Panel contains applets used to configure hardware, the operating  
system and the shell. If your 7530 G2 is running with the Psion Teklogix Tekterm  
application or another application, additional configuration applets may appear in  
the Control Panel.  
Network And Dial-Up Connections  
The Network and Dial-up Connections window allows you to configure the 7530  
G2 radio or execute an existing configuration. Refer to “Configuring An IEEE  
802.11 Radio In The Unit” on page 17 for radio setup details.  
Taskbar And Start Menu  
The Taskbar and Start Menu option displays a dialog box in which you can  
customize the taskbar, choosing which options will be displayed. Refer to  
“Customizing The Taskbar” on page 63 for additional details about this option.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 4: Working With Windows CE  
Run  
4.4.6 Run  
Choosing the Run option from the Start Menu displays a dialog box in which you  
can enter the name of the program, folder or document you want to open or launch.  
Figure 4.6 Run Option  
4.4.7 Shutdown  
The Shutdown menu includes the following options: Suspend, Warm Reset and  
Cold Reset.  
Figure 4.7 Shutdown Sub-Menu  
Note: This menu varies slightly depending on the security level chosen. When  
the 7530 G2 is set to User level, the Shutdown option is replaced by Sus-  
pend. A sub-menu is not available.  
72  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 4: Working With Windows CE  
Using A Dialog Box  
Suspend  
The Suspend option suspends the 7530 G2 immediately – this is equivalent to  
turning the hand-held off.  
Warm Reset  
The Warm Reset option resets the 7530 G2, leaving all saved files and (registry)  
settings intact. Any unsaved data is lost.  
Cold Reset  
The Cold Reset option resets the 7530 G2. Any files not stored in permanent  
memory are lost; however, the registry settings are saved.  
4.5 Using A Dialog Box  
A dialog box (like the samples in Figure 4.8) appears when you need to make  
selections and enter further information.  
You can move between dialog items by tapping on them with your stylus (provided  
your unit is equipped with a touchscreen), or by pressing the arrow keys and the  
[TAB] key. ([SHIFT] [TAB] moves the cursor backwards.)  
Tabs  
Radio  
Button  
Textbox  
Dropdown Menu  
Button  
Checkbox  
Figure 4.8 Dialog Boxes  
Note: If your 7530 G2 touchscreen is enabled, you can use the stylus to tap on  
an element in a dialog box to select or deselect it, display dropdown menu  
items, save your selections, and so on. If your touchscreen is disabled, fol-  
low the directions that follow in this section.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 4: Working With Windows CE  
Using A Dialog Box  
Dialog boxes contain one or more of the following elements:  
Tab: A tab separates different elements of a dialog box. Press the [TAB] key until a  
tab in the dialog box is highlighted. To display adjoining tabs, press the [RIGHT] or  
[LEFT] arrow key. To display the information in the next tab from anywhere in the  
window, press [CTRL] [TAB].  
Textbox: A textbox requires that you type information. Press the [TAB] key to  
highlight the textbox and then type the appropriate information.  
Dropdown: This type of menu is identified by up and down arrows next to the  
dropdown menu to indicate that additional options are available. Press the [TAB]  
key to highlight the menu, and use the arrow keys on your keyboard to cycle  
through the options.  
Checkbox: This box allows you to select or deselect an option. To select or deselect  
a checkbox, press the [TAB] key to highlight the checkbox, and press the [SPACE]  
key to select or deselect it.  
Radio buttons: These buttons allow you to choose from a number of options. For  
example, in the sample screen in Figure 4.8 on page 73 you can choose to Obtain an  
IP address via DHCP or Specify an IP address. Press the [TAB] key to highlight a  
radio button option, and then select a radio button by pressing the arrow keys to  
highlight the appropriate option.  
Buttons: This type of button allows you to Save, Delete and so on the options  
you’ve chosen in a dialog box. Use the [TAB] key to highlight the button you want  
to use. Press the [ENTER] key to activate it.  
Saving Your Choices: Once you’ve made all your changes, press the [ENTER] key  
to save your changes and exit the window.  
Note: A dialog box item that is displayed in grey text indicates that it is not  
currently available.  
74  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5.6.5 Stylus Properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107  
5.6.5.1 Setting Double-Tap Sensitivity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107  
5.6.5.2 Touchscreen Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108  
5.6.5.3 Disabling The Touchscreen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108  
5.6.6 Manage Triggers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109  
5.6.6.1 Trigger Mappings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110  
5.6.6.2 Add And Edit Trigger Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5: Configuration  
5.7.4 Active Conn. Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119  
5.11.2.10 Code 11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154  
5.11.2.11 Interleaved 2 of 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154  
5.11.2.12 MSI Plessey . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155  
5.11.2.13 Discrete 2 of 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155  
5.11.2.14 IATA 2 of 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156  
5.11.3 Decoded (Internal) Scanners. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156  
5.11.3.1 Decoded (Internal) Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157  
76  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5.11.4.12 Code 11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181  
5.11.4.13 Interleaved 2 of 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182  
5.11.4.14 Matrix 2 of 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183  
5.11.4.15 MSI Plessey . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183  
5.11.4.16 Discrete 2 of 5. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .184  
5.11.4.17 2D PDF-417. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185  
5.11.4.18 2D Micro PDF-417 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5: Configuration  
5.11.8.4 Port Replicator Port A (COM5). . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203  
5.12 SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) Setup . . . . . . . . . 204  
5.12.1 Contact Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205  
5.12.1.1 Contact . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205  
5.12.1.2 Location. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205  
5.12.2 Communities Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206  
5.12.2.1 Adding A Community . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206  
78  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5.12.3.1 Enabling Authentication TRAPS. . . . . . . . . . . . . .208  
5.12.3.2 Adding A Destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .208  
5.12.3.3 Changing A Destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209  
5.12.3.4 Removing A Trap Destination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209  
5.12.4 Permitted Hosts Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .210  
5.12.4.1 Adding A Host . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .210  
5.12.4.2 Changing A Host . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Remote Desktop Connection  
5.1 Remote Desktop Connection  
Remote Desktop Connection is a 7530 G2 application used to connect to a  
using the 7530 G2 (Windows CE device).  
Refer to the following website for step-by-step information about setting up this  
connection:  
http://www.microsoft.com/WindowsXP/pro/using/howto/gomobile/remotedesktop/default.asp  
Contact Psion Teklogix personnel if you need help accessing this site. Refer to  
Appendix A: “Support Services And Worldwide Offices” at the back of this manual  
for contact information.  
5.2 The TekTerm Application  
TekTerm is a powerful emulation application ideally suited for real time data  
transaction applications associated with mainframes and servers. The 7530 G2 includes  
unique features that support TekTerm—a Psion Teklogix application that has the ability  
to maintain multiple simultaneous sessions with a variety of host computers. For  
detailed information, refer to the TekTerm Software User Manual, P/N 8000073.  
5.3 Pocket PC Compatibility  
The 7530 G2 supports the AYGShell API set that allows Pocket PC-compatible  
applications to run on the hand-held. Windows CE includes application  
programming interface (API) compatibility support for the Microsoft Windows  
Powered Pocket PC 2002 shell in units running Windows CE.  
The website listed below describes the APIs exposed through AYGShell and the  
application compatibility between Windows Powered Pocket PC 2002-based  
applications and Windows CE-based devices:  
http://msdn.microsoft.com/library/default.asp?url=/library/en-us/dncenet/html/WINCENET_CEPCC_App.asp  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 5: Configuration  
The Control Panel  
5.4 The Control Panel  
The Windows CE Control Panel provides a group of icons through which you can  
set a variety of system-wide properties.  
Note: If you are uncertain how to move around a dialog box and make selec-  
tions, review “Using A Dialog Box” on page 73.  
When the 7530 G2 boots up, the startup desktop (shell) is displayed, and any  
applications stored in the Startup folder start up immediately.  
To access the Control Panel:  
Tap on the Start button in the taskbar to display the Start Menu.  
Tap on Setting>Control Panel.  
If you’re using the keyboard:  
Press [BLUE] [0] to display the Start Menu.  
Highlight Settings in Start Menu, and press the [RIGHT] arrow key to  
highlight Control Panel.  
Press the [ENTER] key.  
The Control Panel folder contains icons used in the setup of your 7530 G2.  
Figure 5.1 Control Panel  
82  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Control Panel Icons  
5.5 Control Panel Icons  
The Control Panel provides a group of icons that allow you to customize and adjust  
settings on your 7530 G2.  
App Launch Keys  
Allows you to map keys to applications so that you can then launch those  
applications from a single key-press.  
Bluetooth  
Provides options for Bluetooth radio setup. It also provides the capability to  
use a Bluetooth-enabled cellular phone as a data modem to exchange infor-  
Certificates  
A public key is transmitted as part of a certificate. The certificate assigned  
through this icon is used to ensure that the submitted public key is, in fact,  
the public key that belongs to the submitter. The client checks that the cer-  
tificate has been digitally signed by a certification authority that the client  
explicitly trusts. “Certificate Assignment” on page 113 directs you to the  
appropriate setup information.  
Date/Time  
Allows you to set the current Month, Date, Time and Time Zone on your unit.  
Dialing  
Specifies dialing settings, including area code, country code, dial type and  
the code to disable call waiting. You can store multiple patterns – for exam-  
ple, ‘Work’, ‘Home’, and so on using this dialog box.  
Display  
Allows you to change the appearance (window colour scheme) of the 7530  
G2 desktop.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Control Panel Icons  
Input Panel  
Provides the framework for a Soft Input Panel (SIP) should you need to  
design your own SIP.  
Internet Options  
Provides options to configure your Internet browser. You can determine  
items such as the default and search page that the browser applies when  
connecting to the Internet, the cache size, the Internet connection options,  
and the security level that is applied when browsing.  
IPv6 Support  
Refers to a new Internet Protocol specification (version 6) that has been  
published to use 128-bit IP addresses (replacing version 4).  
Keyboard  
Toggles character repeat on and off and specifies delay and rate for repeated char-  
acters. It also allows you to adjust the keyboard backlight threshold and intensity.  
Manage Triggers  
Allows multiple-scanner trigger management, including the ability to con-  
figure each of the trigger buttons. You can configure the trigger ID for each  
trigger button for both single- and double-click, and the double-click time.  
Narrow Band Radio  
This icon is displayed only if a Narrow Band radio is installed in the 7530.  
It provides access to the Narrow Band setup screens.  
Network And Dial-up Connections  
Displays a network window from which the 7530 G2 802.11 radio can be  
configured and an existing configuration can be executed. Refer to “Config-  
uring An IEEE 802.11 Radio In The Unit” on page 17 for details.  
84  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Control Panel Icons  
Owner  
Provides fields in which you can specify owner information. A Notes tab  
allows additional information to be entered and displayed when the  
unit is powered up. Network ID tab information is used to access  
System Administrator.)  
Password  
Allows you to assign a password to restrict access to elements of the unit.  
Once assigned, password access cannot be circumvented so it is important  
that you write down your password and keep it in a safe place. Refer to  
“Security Settings” on page 66 for details.  
PC Connection  
Enables direct connections to a desktop computer. Selecting the Change  
your PC.  
Power  
Displays battery pack power status. (Alternately, battery status can be  
accessed through the taskbar.) Additional tabs allow you to determine  
suspend states, to activate card slots and to enable the built-in, Bluetooth  
radio. (Refer to “Power Management Properties” on page 102 for details.)  
RDC Licenses  
The Terminal Services license server stores all license tokens that have been  
installed for a group of terminal servers and tracks licenses issued. The  
Remote Desktop Licenses (RDC) application displays license ‘tokens’ for  
devices that connect to a Terminal Server.  
Region & Language  
Allows you to specify the local language that is to be displayed on the  
hand-held screen along with the format of numbers, currency, time and date  
for your region.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Control Panel Icons  
Remove Programs  
Lists the programs that can be removed from your unit. To remove a pro-  
gram, select it and then click on the Remove button.  
SNMP  
SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) is the protocol used to  
monitor and manage devices attached to a TCP/IP network.  
Storage Manager  
Allows the user to view information about the storage devices that are  
present, such as SD-MMC flash cards.  
Stylus  
Adjusts how Windows CE recognizes your double-tap (as slow or rapid  
successive taps).  
In the Calibration tab, you can recalibrate your touchscreen by tapping  
on the Recalibrate button and following the directions on the screen.  
System  
Displays system and memory properties. In the Memory tab, you can  
allocate memory between storage memory and program memory.  
Teklogix Scanners  
Provides scanner parameters and the bar code symbologies that the 7530  
G2 scanner will successfully read.  
Total Recall  
Provides access to a backup and restore utility to maintain applications and  
settings over cold reboots.  
TweakIT Settings  
Allows you to change Advanced System Settings (interface, network, and  
servers), User System Settings (display font size), and provides the  
Registry Editor.  
86  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Basic Setup  
Volume & Sound  
Allows you to adjust the volume of the sound emitted to indicate events like  
warnings, key clicks and screen taps.  
Wireless WAN  
Provides access to technology like GSM/GPRS and CDMA which allows  
wide area networking capability such as internet browsing via GSM/GPRS.  
5.6 Basic Setup  
5.6.1 Display Properties  
In the Control Panel, choose the Display icon.  
Figure 5.2 Choosing The Display Icon  
5.6.1.1 Display Contrast  
The Contrast tab allows you to adjust the 7530 G2 display contrast to suit the  
environment in which you are using the hand-held. The contrast control can also be  
used to reduce display flickering that can occur with colour displays in certain  
lighting conditions  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Display Properties  
In the Display Properties dialog box, tap on the Contrast tab.  
Slide the bar in the Contrast tab to the left to decrease or darken the  
display contrast.  
Slide the bar to the right to increase or lighten the display contrast.  
5.6.1.2 Display Backlight  
The Display Properties dialog box in the Control Panel allows you to specify the  
intensity of the backlight along with how long the backlight remains on when the  
7530 G2 is not active.  
Note: Keep in mind that this option may be restricted to supervisory use only.  
In the Display Properties dialog box, tap on the Backlight tab.  
Note: Backlight changes take effect immediately. You do not need to reset  
the unit.  
88  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Display Properties  
Important: To maximize battery run time, keep the display backlight bright-  
ness and active durations as low as possible.  
ON Threshold  
The 7530 G2 is equipped with an ambient light sensor. This sliding bar allows you  
to determine how dark the ambient light needs to be before the backlight turns on.  
Intensity  
This parameter is used to adjust the light intensity of the 7530 G2 backlight.  
Sliding the bar to the left lowers the light intensity, and sliding it to the right raises  
the intensity.  
Bright For  
The value chosen from this dropdown menu determines the duration of time that the  
backlight stays on at the configured intensity after the last user action (keypress or  
scan trigger).  
Dim For  
The value chosen from this dropdown menu determines the duration of time that  
the backlight stays on at half the configured intensity (dimmed backlight) after  
expiration of the Bright For delay and as long as no user action takes place (such as  
a keypress or scan trigger). At the expiration of the Dim For duration, the display  
backlight shuts off.  
External Power Checkbox  
When you select the checkbox next to When using external power keep the  
backlight always ON, the backlight remains ON at the configured intensity when  
the 7530 G2 is operating with external power (not battery power). If the 7530 G2 is  
drawing power from its battery, this option is ignored and the other parameters  
defined in Display Properties dialog box take affect.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Keyboard Properties  
5.6.1.3 Display Appearance  
In the Display Properties dialog box, open the Appearance tab.  
This dialog box allows you to customize the display colour scheme.  
5.6.2 Keyboard Properties  
This icon displays the Keyboard Properties dialog box in which you can adjust the  
repeat rate of the keys, the intensity of the keyboard backlight and the behaviour of  
the [BLUE] and [ORANGE] modifier keys. This dialog box also allows you to  
define macro keys and remap the keyboard.  
In the Control Panel, tap on the Keyboard icon.  
Figure 5.3 Choosing The Keyboard Icon  
90  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Keyboard Properties  
5.6.2.1 Key Repeat  
In the Keyboard Properties dialog box, open the Repeat tab.  
Repeat Delay  
The position of the slider determines how long a key must be held down before it  
begins to autorepeat.  
Repeat Rate  
The value assigned for the Repeat Rate parameter determines how quickly the key  
you press repeats and is measured in characters per second (cps). Sliding the bar to  
the left slows the repeat rate, and sliding the bar to the right increases the repeat rate.  
Note: Use the field at the bottom of this dialog box to test the repeat delay and  
rate settings you’ve chosen.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Keyboard Properties  
5.6.2.2 Keyboard Backlight  
In the Keyboard Properties dialog box, open the Backlight tab.  
ON Threshold  
The ON Threshold sliding bar allows you to determine how dark the ambient light  
needs to be before the keyboard backlight turns on.  
Intensity  
This parameter is used to adjust the light intensity of the 7530 G2 keyboard  
backlight. Sliding the bar to the left darkens the keyboard backlight intensity, and  
sliding it to the right lightens the intensity.  
Note: The keypad backlight maximum brightness will decrease over time as it  
ages. Use mid-range intensity settings when possible to extend the back-  
light life span. When the backlight starts to dim, use this parameter to  
make it brighter.  
ON For  
The value chosen from this dropdown menu determines the duration of time that the  
keyboard backlight stays on after the last user action (keypress or scan trigger).  
92  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Keyboard Properties  
5.6.2.3 Keyboard One Shot Modes  
In the Keyboard Properties dialog box, tap on the One Shots tab.  
Figure 5.4 Keyboard One Shot Properties  
The options in this tab allow you to determine how modifier keys on your 7530 G2  
behave. For each modifier key[ALT], [SHIFT], [CTRL], [ORANGE] and  
[BLUE]you have the following options in the drop-down menu: Lock, OneShot,  
and OneShot/Lock.  
Note: The taskbar helps you determine whether or not these keys are locked on.  
For example, if the [ORANGE] key is locked ‘on’, the taskbar at the bot-  
tom of the screen displays it in uppercase characters, ORANGE KEY. If this  
key is displayed in lowercase characters in the taskbar, you’ll know that  
the orange key is not locked. It will become inactive following a key press.  
Important: Once you’ve assigned a One Shot mode to a modifier key, you need to  
tap on the OK button at the top of the tab to activate your selection.  
Lock  
If you choose Lock from the drop-down menu, pressing a modifier key once locks it  
‘on’ until you press the modifier key a second time to unlock or turn it off.  
OneShot  
If you choose OneShot, the modifier key remains active only until the next key is pressed.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Keyboard Properties  
OneShot/Lock  
OneShot/Lock allows you to combine these functions. When you choose this  
option and you press the modifier key once, it remains active only until the next key  
is pressed.  
If you press the modifier key twice, it is locked ‘on’, remaining active until the  
modifier key is pressed a third time to turn it ‘off’.  
5.6.2.4 Keyboard Macro Keys  
In the Keyboard Properties dialog box, open the Macros tab.  
Figure 5.5 Macro Dialog Box  
A macro has 200 programmable characters (or “positions”). The macro keys can be  
programmed to replace frequently used keystrokes, along with the function of  
executable keys including [ENTER], [BKSP] and [DEL] ([BLUE]-[BKSP]),  
function keys and arrow keys.  
Recording And Saving A Macro  
You can program up to 12 macro keys on a 63-key keyboard. On a 37-key keyboard,  
you can program a maximum of 6 macro keys.  
In the Macro menu, highlight a macro key number – for example, macro 1  
to assign a macro to macro key [M1]. Tap on the Record button.  
94  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Keyboard Properties  
A message screen is displayed instructing you to Please Enter Key Strokes  
Type the macro sequence you want to assign to the Macro key. You can  
type text and numbers, and you can program the function of special keys  
into a macro.  
When you’ve finished recording your macro sequence, press the key  
sequence – [CTRL] [ALT] [ENTER], or  
Tap on Stop Recording.  
A new screen displays the macro sequence you created. The Save Macro button  
is highlighted.  
Press [ENTER] to save your macro.  
Note: If you want to discard the macro you’ve just created, highlight the  
Discard Macro button, and press [ENTER].  
Executing A Macro  
To execute a macro:  
Press the macro key to which you’ve assigned the macro. For example, if  
you created a macro for macro key 1, press [M1] to execute the macro.  
Deleting A Macro  
To delete a macro:  
In the Macros tab, highlight the macro number you want to delete.  
Tap on the Delete button.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Keyboard Properties  
5.6.2.5 Unicode Mapping  
In the Keyboard Properties dialog box, open the Unicode Mapping tab.  
Figure 5.6 Unicode Mapping  
The Unicode Mapping tab is used to map combinations of virtual key values and  
[CTRL] and [SHIFT] states to Unicode™ values. This tab shows the configured  
Unicode character along with the Unicode value. For example, the sample screen  
above shows “a (U+0061)” indicating that the character “a” is represented by the  
Unicode value “0061”, and so on. Keep in mind that Unicode configurations are  
represented as hexadecimal rather than decimal values.  
All user-defined Unicode mappings are listed in the Unicode Mapping tab in order  
of virtual key value, and then by order of the shift state. If a Unicode mapping is not  
listed, the Unicode mapping is mapped to the default Unicode value.  
96  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Keyboard Properties  
Adding And Changing Unicode Values  
Important: Changes to Unicode mappings are not saved until you exit the  
Keyboard Properties dialog box.  
Tap on the Add/Change button.  
Highlight a value in the Unicode mapping list – in the sample screen above,  
a value will be assigned to virtual key 0 (VK 0).  
Position the cursor in the Unicode Mapping field, and type a Unicode  
value for the highlighted key.  
Note: To add a shifted state – [SHIFT] and/or [CTRL], press [TAB] to position  
the cursor in the checkbox next to ‘SHIFT Pressed’ and/or ‘CTRL  
Pressed’. Press [SPACE] to select the shift state you want to assign.  
Removing Unicode Values  
In the Unicode Mapping tab, highlight the item you want to delete, and  
choose the Remove button.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Keyboard Properties  
5.6.2.6 Scancode Remapping  
A scancode is a number that is associated with a physical key on a keyboard. Every  
key has a unique scancode that is mapped to a virtual key, a function or a macro.  
Scancode Remapping allows you to change the functionality of any key on the  
keyboard. A key can be remapped to send a virtual key (e.g. VK_F represents the  
‘F’ key; VK_RETURN represents the [ENTER/ON] key, etc.), perform a function  
(e.g. turn the scanner on, change volume/contrast, etc.) or run a macro.  
There are three different tables of scancode mappings: the Normal table, the Blue  
table and the Orange table. The Normal table defines unmodified key presses; the  
Blue table defines key presses that occur when the [BLUE] modifier is on; the  
Orange table defines key presses that occur when the [ORANGE] modifier is on.  
The default mappings of these scancodes can be overwritten for each of these three  
tables using the Scancode Remapping tab accessed from the Keyboard Properties  
dialog box.  
Figure 5.7 Scancode Remapping  
The first column in the Scancode Remapping tab displays the scancodes in  
hexadecimal. If the scancode is remapped to a virtual key, that virtual key is  
displayed in the next column labelled ‘V-Key’. A virtual key that is ‘Shifted’ or  
‘Unshifted’ is displayed in the third column labelled ‘Function’.  
If the scancode is remapped to a function or a macro, the first and second columns  
remain blank while the third column contains the function name or macro key  
number (e.g., Macro 2).  
98  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Keyboard Properties  
Adding A Remap  
To add a new remapping:  
Tap on the Add button at the bottom of the dialog box.  
The Remap Scancode dialog box is displayed.  
Type the scan code in hexadecimal in the field labelled Scancode  
Note: The Label field displays the default function of the scancode you  
are remapping.  
Virtual Key, Function And Macro  
The radio buttons at the bottom of the dialog box allow you to define to what the  
scan code will be remapped: Virtual Key, Function or Macro.  
When Virtual Key is selected, you can choose to force [SHIFT] to be on or off when  
the virtual key is sent. If No Force is selected, the shift state is dependent on whether  
the shift state is on or off at the time the virtual key is sent.  
When Function is selected, a list of valid functions appears in the dialog box.  
When Macro is selected, the macro keys available on your unit are listed in the  
dialog box.  
Choose Virtual Key, Function or Macro.  
Choose a function from the Function list in the dialog box, and tap on OK.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Volume And Sound Properties  
Editing A Scancode Remap  
To edit a scancode:  
In the Scancode Remapping tab, tap the stylus on the remap you want  
to edit.  
Tap on the Edit button, and make the appropriate changes.  
Tap on OK to save your changes.  
Removing A Remap  
To delete a remap:  
In the Scancode Remapping tab, highlight the scancode you want to delete,  
and tap on the Remove button.  
Tap on OK.  
5.6.3 Volume And Sound Properties  
Note: Additional sounds can be generated by the application installed in your  
7530 G2.  
In the Control Panel, tap on the Volume & Sounds icon.  
Figure 5.8 Choosing The Volume Icon  
100 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Volume And Sound Properties  
5.6.3.1 Volume Adjustments  
Slide the volume button to the left to lower the beeper volume or to the right  
to increase the beeper volume.  
Under the heading Enable sounds for, enable the conditions under which  
you want the 7530 G2 to emit a beep.  
5.6.3.2 Sound  
The 7530 G2 hand-held computer is equipped with a sound port. This dialog box  
allows you to determine the sound file that will be emitted from this port.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Power Management Properties  
5.6.4 Power Management Properties  
This icon displays the Power Properties dialog box that indicates the unit’s battery  
capacity and allows you to manage battery use.  
In the Control Panel, tap on the Power icon.  
Figure 5.9 Choosing The Power Icon  
5.6.4.1 Battery Capacity  
Inthe Power Properties dialog box, open the Battery tab to view battery details.  
102 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Power Management Properties  
5.6.4.2 Power Saving Schemes  
In the Power Properties dialog box, open the Schemes tab.  
Power Scheme  
This dropdown menu allows you to specify whether the unit is using AC Power or  
Battery Power.  
Switch State To Suspend  
Important: Psion Teklogix recommends setting the Suspend value to 10 min-  
utes. Setting ‘Switch State To Suspend’ to ‘Never’ will adversely  
affect the battery run time.  
To further reduce power consumption, carefully consider the  
duration of time that the display backlight is ‘on’ (see “Display  
Backlight” on page 88).  
When the 7530 G2 is idle – not receiving any user input (a key touch, a scan, and so  
on) or system activity (serial data, an activity initiated by an application, and so on),  
the value chosen in the Suspend Timeout dropdown menu determines when the unit  
will go to suspend state (appear to be off).  
When the time in the Suspend Timeout field elapses without any activity, the unit  
enters Suspend state. In Suspend state, the 7530 G2 CPU enters a sleep state, and the  
radio is shut off. The state of the device (RAM contents) is preserved. Pressing  
[ENTER] wakes the system from suspend state. When the 7530 G2 is in suspend  
state, the network connection is broken immediately; you must re-establish the  
network connection.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Power Management Properties  
5.6.4.3 Suspend Threshold  
The Suspend Threshold adjustment tells the system when to shut down when the  
battery drains. If you choose Maximum Operating Time, the unit will run until the  
battery is completely empty; the RAM is only backed up for a short period of time.  
If you choose Maximum Backup Time, the hand-held shuts off with more energy left  
in the battery so RAM can be backed up for a longer period of time.  
Important: Selecting Maximum backup time will reserve approximately 20%  
of the battery capacity for memory backup. Once the battery drains  
the system, RAM memory is lost and the unit must cold boot.  
In most real-time transaction environments this is not a problem  
(it only takes a few seconds to cold boot). Batch transaction envi-  
ronments, where data is not saved to a non-volatile memory (such  
as an SD FLASH card), may need to pay particular attention to  
this parameter. Psion Teklogix does not recommend the storage of  
any valuable data in system RAM.  
The 7530 G2 normal Windows CE environment does not store  
any critical data in RAM (such as the registry or file system).  
If the user's application does not save data to RAM,  
Psion Teklogix recommends keeping the Suspend Threshold  
setting as low as possible to maximize battery run time.  
104 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Power Management Properties  
5.6.4.4 Calibrate  
Tapping in the checkbox next to Allow Battery Calibration allows the battery to be  
recalibrated only when necessary if the unit is inserted in a Combo Docking station.  
5.6.4.5 Advanced Power Properties  
Allow Suspend With  
This tab allows you to specify whether or not your unit will enter suspend state  
while is operating with an active PPP connection, network interface or active  
TCP/IP connection.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Power Management Properties  
Low Power Warning  
The sliding scale under this section of the tab allows you to specify the remaining  
battery capacity at which a warning message is displayed on the 7530 G2 screen –  
0% to 20%.  
5.6.4.6 Devices  
This tab enables or disables power to individual CF, PC Card and SDIO slots in the unit.  
Slot Power Status  
This tab allows you to enable or disable power to the individual CF, PC Card and  
SDIO slots in your unit.  
Built-In Devices Power Status  
A checkmark next to Enable Bluetooth activates the unit’s built-in, Bluetooth radio.  
106 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Stylus Properties  
5.6.5 Stylus Properties  
Note: Touchscreen calibration may not be enabled on your unit. If your screen  
appears to require recalibration, contact your supervisor.  
In the Control Panel, tap on the Stylus icon.  
Figure 5.10 Stylus Icon  
5.6.5.1 Setting Double-Tap Sensitivity  
In the Double-Tap tab, follow the directions to tailor the sensitivity of the  
stylus when you tap on the touchscreen.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Stylus Properties  
5.6.5.2 Touchscreen Calibration  
Touchscreens rarely require recalibration. However, if your touchscreen has never  
been calibrated or if you find that the stylus pointer is not accurate when you tap on  
an item, follow the directions below.  
Tap on the Calibration tab, and then on the Recalibrate button.  
Follow the directions in the Calibration tab to recalibrate the screen.  
5.6.5.3 Disabling The Touchscreen  
This tab allows you to disable the touchscreen.  
To disable the touchscreen, tap in the checkbox next to Disable the  
touch panel.  
108 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Manage Triggers  
5.6.6 Manage Triggers  
The Manage Triggers icon allows you to configure how bar code scanners and other  
devices such as RFID readers are triggered. You can configure the trigger ID for  
each trigger button for both single- and double-click, and the double-click time.  
In the Control Panel, tap on the Manage Triggers icon.  
Figure 5.11 Choosing The Manage Trigger Icon  
In the Manage Triggers screen you’ll see a list of trigger mappings.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Manage Triggers  
5.6.6.1 Trigger Mappings  
A trigger mapping is an association between a particular key on the keyboard and a  
driver or application, the “owner(s)” of the trigger source. When the specified key is  
pressed, the owner (for example, a decoded scanner) is sent a message.  
Important: It is not possible to have two or more identical mappings—for  
example [F1] cannot be mapped to the Non-Decoded Scanner  
twice—even if the trigger type is different.  
A keyboard key that is used as a trigger source will no longer gen-  
erate key data or perform its normal function. For example, if the  
space button is used as a trigger source, it will not be able to send  
space characters to applications.  
Double-Click  
When a key is pressed and released, then pressed again within the configured time  
(between 0 to 1000 milliseconds), a double-click occurs. See also “Trigger Type” on  
page 112.  
Show All  
By default, the trigger mapping list only shows active mappings. Mappings for  
drivers or applications that are not currently active are not normally displayed. By  
checking this checkbox, all mappings, both active and inactive, are displayed.  
Add  
Tapping this button brings up the Add mapping dialog (see below), so that you can  
add new trigger mappings.  
Edit  
Tapping this button brings up the Edit mapping dialog, so that you can edit existing  
trigger mappings.  
Remove  
Tapping this button removes an existing mapping.  
OK  
The OK button in the top right of the Manage Triggers screen saves all changes  
made. If the cancel button X is tapped instead, or the [ESC] key is pressed, all  
changes made will be discarded.  
110 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Manage Triggers  
5.6.6.2 Add And Edit Trigger Mapping  
Tap on the Add button to add a new trigger map, or on the Edit button to  
edit an existing trigger map.  
Figure 5.12 Add Trigger Mapping Menus  
Source  
This dropdown list allows you to specify the source of the trigger events, such as a  
keyboard key [F1], the grip trigger, etc., for the Trigger Owner selected.  
Notes: It is possible to map the same source to different owners—for example,  
[F1] can be mapped to both the Imager and Non-Decoded Scanner. If so,  
both devices/operations will occur simultaneously. This is not recom-  
mended in most cases, especially with devices such as Imagers or RFID  
Readers.  
It is also possible to map different sources to the same owner—for exam-  
ple, [F2] and [F3] can both be mapped to the RFID File System.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Manage Triggers  
Add Source  
Only existing trigger sources are shown in the Source combo-box. To add a new  
source to this list, tap on the Add Source button. A dialog box pops up, allowing  
you to select the keyboard key to use as a trigger source.  
Figure 5.13 Add Source Dialog  
Trigger Type  
You can enable either an Up/Down or Double Click response to a trigger press.  
Normally, when a trigger (keyboard key, etc.) is pressed and released, a “trigger  
down” event is sent to the “owner”—that is, the application receiving the trigger  
press information—followed by a “trigger up”. If Double Click is chosen in this  
menu, when the trigger is pressed, released, and then pressed again, a “double-click”  
event will occur. If a mapping with the type Up/down has also been configured for  
the same source, it will only receive the first set of trigger events.  
Trigger Owner  
This identifies the driver or application receiving the trigger presses.  
Show All  
By default, inactive owners are not shown. By checking this checkbox, all owners,  
both active and inactive, are displayed.  
112 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Certificate Assignment  
5.6.7 Certificate Assignment  
In the Control Panel, tap on the Certificate icon.  
Figure 5.14 Certificates Icon  
This dialog box is used in conjunction with 802.1x authentication to enhance  
7530 G2 security.  
For a detailed description about Certificate setup for both the server and client-side  
devices (7530 G2s), refer to the following website:  
www.microsoft.com/windows2000/techinfo/planning/walkthroughs/default.asp - "Security Services"  
Note: When importing certificates, the 7530 G2 only recognizes .cer files.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Bluetooth Setup  
5.7 Bluetooth Setup  
Bluetooth is a global standard for wireless connectivity for digital devices and is  
intended for Personal Area Networks (PAN). The technology is based on a  
short-range radio link that operates in the ISM band at 2.4 GHz. When two  
Bluetooth-equipped devices come within a 5 meter range of each other, they can  
establish a connection. Because Bluetooth utilizes a radio-based link, it does not  
require a line-of-sight connection in order to communicate.  
Note: The Bluetooth radio uses an internal antenna.  
In the Control Panel, tap on the Bluetooth Devices icon to display the  
Bluetooth Control dialog box.  
Figure 5.15 Bluetooth Icon  
The Bluetooth Control dialog box is used to display the other Bluetooth devices  
with which you can communicate.  
114 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5: Configuration  
The Devices Tab  
5.7.1 The Devices Tab  
Note: If you intend to configure Bluetooth communication with specific devices  
(e.g., a scanner or printer), turn on the devices and bring them within 5  
metres of the hand-held before proceeding with the discovery process  
described below.  
Scan  
Tap on the Scan button to list available devices.  
Wait for the 7530 G2 to complete its scan (approximately 20 seconds). When  
scanning starts, the Scan button will change to Stop – if necessary, you can  
tap on this button to stop the process. Once scanning is complete, all discovered  
devices will be displayed in the list box, with Name, Address, Active status,  
and PIN information.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 5: Configuration  
The Devices Tab  
Note: During the scanning process, addresses are located first, followed by  
names. Only the names of devices that are within the Bluetooth radio cov-  
erage range will be retrieved.  
The Active column indicates whether any service is activated for that device. When  
a service is activated, the device is displayed in the list even when it is not detected  
during the scan.  
The PIN column indicates whether you have a PIN (password) set for the device.  
At this point you can either query for services or set the PIN for each device. Once  
you highlight a device in the list box, both the Services and Set PIN buttons  
become available.  
Services  
A discovered device may display several service profiles that it can use to  
communicate, and you will want to activate the type you need. Supported profiles  
that can be activated include: DUN (Dial-Up Networking service), Printer (serial  
service), and LANPPP (LANAccessUsingPPP service). ASync (ActiveSync) is  
another available profile.  
To start the service scan, highlight a device in the Devices tab list, and then  
click on the Services button or double-click on the device entry.  
Note: If the remote device is out of reach or turned off, it can take a consider-  
able amount of time for the Services dialog box to appear – it may appear  
to be frozen.  
Once the device’s service profiles are displayed in the Services list box:  
Highlight the service to be activated.  
Press [SPACE] or right-click to display the Activation menu.  
The Activation menu contains four options – Activate, Authenticate, Outgoing and  
Encrypt.  
Once the service is successfully activated, the assigned port (if applicable) will  
appear in the Port column of the Services list box. You can choose to use BSP or  
COM as the port name. BSP is the latest Microsoft Bluetooth stack standard, but  
older applications assume serial ports are COM. When using COM as the port name,  
the Bluetooth manager will try to find and use a free port between COM7 and  
COM9. When using BSP as the port name, BSP2 to BSP9 are available for use. The  
port is available as soon as it is activated.  
116 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 5: Configuration  
The Devices Tab  
Note: The CH column shows the RFCOMM channel of the service if the  
service is RFCOMM-based. This information is not generally needed  
except for debugging purposes.  
To add a service to the Outgoing port, an active service must first be deactivated.  
Then you can choose the ‘Outgoing’ option from the Activation menu (highlight a  
service, right-click or press the [SPACE] bar to display the Activation menu).  
The Authentication and Encryption options can be changed only before activation.  
To change these after activation, deactivate the service first, then change the options.  
Once a service is activated, all the information regarding the service, including the  
RFCOMM channel number, is saved in the registry. (Some remote devices may  
change their RFCOMM channel numbers when they reboot, so your saved setting  
may not work when the remote device is rebooted. In that case, you must deactivate  
the service and reactivate it to detect the current RFCOMM channel.)  
Set PIN  
PINs can be set for each device by pressing the Set PIN button in the Devices tab, or  
you can skip this step and try to connect to the device first.  
Important: The remote device must have authentication enabled, otherwise  
the PIN authentication will fail.  
Highlight a device, click on the Set Pin button, and type the PIN.  
You will receive a message, either that the PIN has been successfully validated or  
that it has been rejected.  
If the PIN has been validated, an asterisk (*) appears in the PIN column in the  
Devices list box, indicating that this device has a PIN set. Once a PIN is entered, it is  
saved in the registry.  
To remove the PIN:  
Choose Set PIN, and press [ENTER].  
If the 7530 G2 attempts to connect to a remote device that has Authentication  
enabled and does not have a required PIN set, an Authentication Request dialog  
box appears.  
Enter the PIN, and tap on OK to connect the devices.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5: Configuration  
The Servers Tab  
5.7.2 The Servers Tab  
The Bluetooth connection is initiated from your 7530 G2 to the remote device –  
therefore the 7530 G2 is called the ‘client’ and the remote is called the ‘server’. The  
Servers tab displays the server profiles that can be activated in your 7530 G2. There  
is currently one server profile available: Serial.  
Tap on the checkbox to activate the server, and it will display the associated  
port name beside the server name.  
Once you activate a server profile, it is recommended that the 7530 G2 be rebooted  
before you try to bond from a server.  
Note: You do not need to reboot if you are deactivating a server.  
5.7.3 Outgoing Tab  
Outgoing Port acts as a serial port that can be used to connect to a list of Bluetooth  
devices (one at a time), but you have the freedom to switch on-the-fly.  
The Outgoing Port checkbox allows you to create the Outgoing port. When the port is  
created, the Outgoing tab lists the port name.  
118 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Active Conn. Tab  
The Outgoing list dialog box displays a list of services marked as ‘Outgoing’. The *  
column indicates the currently selected service. You can tap on Unselect to reset the  
current selection, or you can tap on Select to make a selection. The Remove button  
deletes the service from the outgoing list.  
The Prompt menu determines the behaviour of the pop-up Selection menu.  
Choosing Everytime causes the Selection menu to be displayed each time an  
outgoing port is created. If you choose Once, the menu is displayed only when a  
partner service is not selected.  
To display the Selection menu at any time:  
Press [CTRL] [ALT] [F1], and switch the partner Bluetooth device.  
If a connection to a partner device already exists, the connection is dropped and  
another connection to the newly selected device is created instantly without  
disrupting the application that has opened the outgoing port.  
Note: To add a service to the Outgoing port, an active service must first be  
deactivated. Then you can choose the ‘Outgoing’ option from the Activa-  
tion menu (highlight a service, right-click or press the [SPACE] bar to  
display the Activation menu).  
5.7.4 Active Conn. Tab  
The Active Conn. tab lists the Name, Address, and Type of the currently active  
connections. The table is periodically updated, but it can take a few seconds before  
it reflects the actual list of connections. The Type column of the table shows ‘ACL’  
or ‘SCO’. The Connection list table shows the connections for scanning as well as  
the service connections.  
Note: You can change the device-name and description of your radio by clicking  
on the System icon in Control Panel, which will open the System Proper-  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5: Configuration  
The Properties Tab  
ties dialog box. Click on the Device Name tab to access the menu and  
change your settings. Then click on OK.  
Although the name will have changed in the Properties menu in Bluetooth  
Controls, the radio only reads it on boot-up. For the changes to take  
effect, you must cold reset the 7530 G2 (see“Cold Reset” on page 27).  
5.7.5 The Properties Tab  
The Properties tab displays information about your 7530 G2, and provides some  
port options.  
The Device Name field shows the device name of your 7530 G2. This name can be  
changed (see the Note on the previous page for details).  
Device Class shows the Class of Device (e.g. desktop, hand-held), which is always  
set to Handheld.  
Local Bluetooth Address shows the address of your 7530 G2 radio.  
Port Prefix is used to set the port name to either BSP or COM. When the name is set  
to BSP, BSP2 to BSP9 are available for activated services (including the server).  
When COM is chosen, COM7 to COM9 are available.  
NQuery Retry (Name Query Retry) governs the number of times the hand-held will  
attempt to query the names of other Bluetooth devices if the first attempt fails.  
(When the 7530 G2 scans for other devices, it sometimes fails to scan names.)  
120 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Bluetooth GPRS Connection  
5.7.6 Bluetooth GPRS Connection  
1. To set up the internet parameters, tap on the Network And Dial-up  
Connections icon.  
Figure 5.16 Network And Dial-up Connection Icon  
2. Tap on the Make New Connection icon.  
Figure 5.17 Creating A GPRS Connection  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Bluetooth GPRS Connection  
3. In the Make New Connection dialog box, tap on Dial-Up Connection.  
Enter a name for your GPRS network connection.  
Figure 5.18 Setting Up The Connection  
4. Tap on the Next button to display the Modem dialog box.  
Figure 5.19 Setting Up The Modem  
5. In the dropdown menu labelled Select a modem, choose the name  
of the modem with which you want to connect, and then tap on the  
Configure button to display the Device Properties dialog box.  
122 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Bluetooth GPRS Connection  
The 7530 G2 communicates via Bluetooth to your Bluetooth-equipped cel-  
lular telephone and retrieves the parameters for the Device Properties  
dialog box. The 7530 G2 then disconnects.  
Figure 5.20 Port Settings  
6. Under the Call Options tab, turn off Cancel the call if not connected  
within, and press [ENTER] to save your changes.  
Figure 5.21 Call Options  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Bluetooth GPRS Connection  
7. In the Modem dialog box, tap on the Next button to display the Phone  
Number dialog box.  
Figure 5.22 Setting The Phone Number  
The phone number you enter is network carrier dependent. Once you’ve  
specified all the necessary information, choose the Finish button.  
8. In the Control Panel, choose the Dialing icon.  
Figure 5.23 Dialing Icon  
124 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Bluetooth GPRS Connection  
9. The values in the Dialing Properties dialog box need to be edited  
according to your network carrier specifications.  
Figure 5.24 Setting Up Dialing Properties  
Once you’ve edited this dialog box to reflect your network carrier require-  
ments, press [ENTER] to save your changes.  
10. At this point, you’ll need to return to the Control Panel, and choose the  
Network and Dial-up Connections icon.  
11. In the network connection window, the new network configuration – in  
this case – GPRS Network – is displayed. Tap on the new icon.  
Figure 5.25 GPRS Network Connection  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Total Recall  
An onscreen message will be displayed indicating the status of your con-  
nection – connected, disconnected, error messages, and so on.  
Tap on the Hide button to move this message to the background.  
You can now access the internet.  
5.8 Total Recall  
Total Recall is a Psion Teklogix utility developed to maintain applications setting  
over cold boots. This utility is based on a backup and restore concept.  
In the Control Panel, tap on the Total Recall icon  
Figure 5.26 Total Recall Icon  
5.8.1 Creating A Backup Profile  
126 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Creating A Backup Profile  
In the dropdown menu, you can choose from four options: Create Backup Profile,  
View Selected Profile, Restore Selected Profile and Delete Selected Profile. Keep in  
mind however that until a profile is created, the only available option is Create  
Backup Profile.  
Tap on the Next button to begin the process.  
Profile Information  
This dialog box lists the possible storage destinations for the profile file.  
To begin, type a name for the profile in the field labelled Profile Name.  
The image type – OS Version and Registry Type for the 7530 G2 is also listed here.  
Tap on this icon  
to expand your settings for AutoRetore Profile and  
Profile Location.  
For this device only – creates a backup that is manually restored by  
the operator.  
AutoRestore for this device only – creates a profile that automatically  
restores itself following a cold boot.  
AutoRestore for this and other devices – creates a profile that automati-  
cally restores after resuming from a cold boot, but it will not contain the  
touchscreen calibration coordinates or the Wireless radio settings.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Creating A Backup Profile  
Profile Location – allows the operator to specify where the profile is to  
be saved. The location for the profile is either \Flash Disk or  
\SD-MMC Card.  
Choose the Next button to display the next dialog box – Add Files.  
Add Files  
By default, All Files is selected so that all installed or copied files, database entries,  
and the Registry will be saved. You can, however, limit the backup to databases,  
and/or the registry only. By tapping the checkbox next to these items, you can add or  
remove a check mark to enable or disable the option.  
The Select Files option allows you to select predefined file types.  
Remove the check mark next to All Files. You’ll notice the checkbox next  
to Select Files changes , indicating that additional options are available.  
Tap on this icon  
next to Select Files to view your options.  
Figure 5.27 Selecting Files  
128 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Creating A Backup Profile  
Choosing By Individual File displays a pop-up menu where you can tailor the list of  
files you want to back up.  
Figure 5.28 Adding Files  
To add a file to your backup list:  
Tap on Add Files. Browse to and choose the files you want to add to  
your list.  
Choosing By File Type allows you to select the file types that you want backed up.  
Figure 5.29 Adding Files By File Type  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Restoring A Profile  
View Selections  
Depending on what you have selected for inclusion in your profile, you can view a  
list of the selected files, databases and/or registry.  
Choose the Next button to perform the operation.  
Performing The Backup  
Tap on the Backup button to start the process, and create a profile.  
5.8.2 Restoring A Profile  
To manually restore a profile:  
Tap on Restore Selected Profile from the dropdown menu, and choose the  
Profile Name displayed in the drop down box.  
130 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5: Configuration  
IPv6 Support  
Note: You can also manually restore an auto restore profile located in flash or a  
storage device.  
5.9 IPv6 Support  
The IPv6 Support icon in the Control Panel allows you to activate IPv6 network  
support on your unit. This internet protocol specification (version 6) supports  
128-bit IP addresses, replacing version 4.  
Figure 5.30 IPv6 Support Icon  
Choose the IPv6 Support icon to display the associated dialog box.  
Choose the checkbox next to Enable IPv6 Network Support to enable this  
internet protocol.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Narrow Band Radio Setup  
5.10 Narrow Band Radio Setup  
Keep in mind that the Narrow Band icon is only visible in the 7530 G2 Control  
Panel when a Narrow Band radio is installed in the unit.  
In the Control Panel, tap on the Narrow Band Radio icon.  
5.10.1 Info Tab  
In the Narrow Band Radio dialog box, the Info tab displays information about the  
radio – it cannot be edited.  
The Power information in this screen indicates the power of the radio installed in  
the unit – 0.5 or 1.0 W. The “Serial Number” is the identifier for the radio and is  
used by the protocol when the “Auto Radio Address” parameter is enabled. The  
“CIS Data” (Card Information Structure) is manufacturer information describing the  
PC Card installed in the 7530 G2. “DSP x.x / FPGA 0xNN” indicates the firmware  
revision of the radio’s DSP (x.x) and FPGA (0xNN) where x.x and NN represent  
actual revision numbers.  
Statistics Screen  
Tap on the Statistics button to display the Protocol Statistics screen.  
132 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Info Tab  
These statistics are updated every second while the dialog box is displayed.  
The following table provides a brief description of these statistics:  
Statistic  
Description  
Channel quality. See the description of the “Channel Switch Speed” parame-  
ter in the channel tab for more information on how “cq” affects channel  
switching (see “Channel Switch Speed” on page 136).  
cq  
ch  
sc  
Current channel  
Monitor state of RF Link: LOCKED=0, LOCKPENDING=1, LOWC-  
QWAIT=2, SCANNING=3, STARTUP=4, ABANDON=5  
rm  
xm  
rf  
Number of received messages, complete application messages  
Number of transmitted messages, complete application messages  
Number of received polls with attached message  
Number of transmitted frames  
xf  
ra  
Number of received radio link aborts  
Number of transmitted radio link initialization messages  
Number of received polls  
xi  
rp  
xr  
Number of transmitted retries  
pt  
Number of poll timeouts  
xe  
rssi  
Number of transmitted errors  
Received Signal Strength Indicator  
Table 5.1 Protocol Statistics Descriptions  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Info Tab  
Low Level Screen  
Tap on the Low Level tab to display the Low Level statistics screen.  
Table 5.2 defines the elements of the Low Level statistics screen.  
Statistic  
RxOk  
RxHd  
RxBd  
RxEr  
RxOv  
TxOk  
TxEr  
Description  
Message buffers discarded due to lack of available receive buffers  
Message headers successfully received  
Message bodies successfully received  
Message buffers received with detected errors  
Number of transmitted messages, complete application messages  
Message buffers successfully transmitted  
Message buffers which failed to transmit  
CD  
Number of carrier detect changes detected  
Number of collisions detected  
Coll  
Actual difference in time (in RTC ticks) between when the most recent trans-  
mit (with timestamp) was scheduled to start and when it actually started.  
Tx D  
TxMD  
Rx X  
Maximum "Tx D" value  
Number of extra characters received for last received message (due to delay  
in host reporting back actual body size)  
RxMx  
MChg  
Maximum "Rx X" value  
Number of completed mode changes  
Table 5.2 Low Level Statistics Descriptions  
134 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Channel Tab  
Default All Parameters  
Tap on the Default all Parameters button to return all registry parameters  
to default values.  
When this button is pressed, a screen appears asking if you’re sure you want to  
return all parameters to their default values.  
Tap on the Yes button to return values to their default settings.  
Note: This button does not default the radio parameters set under the Radio tab.  
5.10.2 Channel Tab  
Channel Number  
This parameter determines the operating radio channel of the 7530 G2. The  
allowable range for this parameter is 1to 20. The default value is 1.  
Note: The Channel Number dropdown menu displays only the channels that  
have been enabled in the Channel Enable List.  
Power Up Channel  
When this parameter is enabled (checked), the 7530 G2 begins communicating on  
the channel specified in the Channel Number parameter when the unit is powered  
up. This setting may prevent the migration of 7530 G2s to the same channel due to  
uneven coverage in some sites.  
If this parameter is disabled (unchecked), the unit will continue communicating on  
the same channel that it was on before it was powered off.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Channel Tab  
Channel Enable List  
Tap on the Channel Enable List button to display a dialog box listing  
available channels.  
This dialog box is completed by default with all channels that have frequencies  
configured. A checkmark indicates that a channel is enabled. An unchecked check  
box indicates that the channel is disabled. The maximum number of channels  
supported by the RA1001 Narrow Band radio is 20.  
Enabling a channel allows the channel to be set to an operating channel (Channel  
Number) and makes it available for channel searching. For example, if Channel 1 is  
the operating channel and all other channels are enabled, the 7530 G2 can roam  
through all 20 channels.  
Channel Switch Speed  
This parameter changes the threshold the 7530 G2 uses to determine when  
communication quality with a base station is unacceptable. When this threshold is  
exceeded, the unit starts channel searching for a new base station.  
Setting this parameter to “Slow” means a higher threshold – the 7530 G2 is more  
tolerant of poor communication quality. When the channel quality of the hand-held  
radio drops below 46%, the unit monitors the channel quality for 15 timeout periods  
before searching for a new channel. If Channel Switch Speed is set to “Fast”, the  
current channel is only monitored for up to 2 time-out periods before channel  
switching begins.  
Important: “Fast” switch speed is most effective where coverage areas are  
largely overlapping. If the coverage areas barely overlap, have  
dead spots, or if the 7530 G2 frequently operates on the fringe of  
coverage, this parameter should be set to “Slow”.  
136 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Channel Tab  
Channel Selection  
Enabling “Manual Select” allows you to set the channel search order the 7530 G2  
will use if communication quality drops and channel switching is required. If this  
parameter is enabled, the 7530 G2 uses the channel switching lists specified in the  
Manual Switch Table. If this parameter is disabled (unchecked), the hand-held uses  
a standard algorithm to decide which channel it should switch to in the event of poor  
channel quality.  
Warning:  
It is not recommended that the “Manual Select” parameter be used  
without a clear understanding of how to order the channel  
sequences for optimum performance.  
Manual Switch Table  
Tap on the Set Switch Table button to display the Manual Switch Table  
dialog box.  
This feature is used rarely. It is used when the order of channel switching needs to be  
tightly controlled. The values in the “Channel” column are completed for you with  
the enabled channels when this dialog box is opened. For each corresponding  
enabled channel, the “List” column contains “0,0,0,0,0,0,0,0” values by default.  
If communication quality falls below 46%, only the channels entered in the Manual  
Switch Table are considered for channel switching. The channel search is carried out  
in the order in which the channels were entered in the table.  
To configure channel switching order for a particular channel:  
Highlight the channel you want to edit, and tap on the Edit Channel  
List button.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Protocol Tab  
Editing The Channel List  
Only those channels that are enabled are displayed in the dropdown menus in the  
Edit Channel List dialog box. The allowable values range from 0 to 20.  
Tap on the arrow next to dropdown menu to scroll through the available  
channels. Highlight the value you want to assign.  
Once you’ve assigned the switching order, tap on the OK button to close  
the dialog box.  
The channel list is added to the selected channel in the Manual Switch Table  
dialog box.  
5.10.3 Protocol Tab  
Enable Cellular Protocol  
The value assigned to this parameter must be identical to the value assigned to the  
corresponding parameter in the Psion Teklogix Network Controller, Wireless  
Gateway or Base Station. A warm reset of the 7530 G2 is required before this  
parameter can take effect.  
If Enable Cellular Protocol is disabled (unchecked), the options in the Cellular  
Radio Address frame are displayed in grey text indicating that they cannot  
be accessed.  
138 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Protocol Tab  
Cellular Radio Address  
Auto Radio Address  
If Auto radio address is enabled, the 7530 G2 requests an automatically assigned  
radio address. Manual radio address is displayed in grey text indicating that it  
cannot be accessed.  
Manual Radio Address  
The value entered in the Manual Radio Address parameter is used to identify  
the 7530 G2 over the radio link. A unique value from 1 to 3840 must be assigned for  
each unit.  
Note: This parameter is set to ‘0’ (an out-of-range value) by default to block  
radio communication when the unit is initially powered up. This prevents  
several new hand-helds from attempting to communicate with the same  
default terminal number at initial power up. Once the default value is  
changed, it cannot be set back to ‘0’.  
Polling  
The default values for the Polling parameters are dependent on the value assigned to  
the Modulation / Baud Rate parameter in the Radio tab.  
Modulation / Baud Rate  
4 Level / 19200  
4 Level / 9600  
Sync Delay Window Delay Poll Timeout  
17  
17  
17  
25  
20  
23  
19  
23  
20  
25  
22  
37  
2 Level / 9600  
2 Level / 4800  
Table 5.3 Polling Parameters  
Sync Delay  
Warning:  
This parameter should not be changed from its factory setting  
without a clear understanding of radio protocol timing.  
The “Sync Delay” parameter specifies the delay between the base station  
transmission and the first response window, measured in milliseconds. The value  
assigned to this parameter must be compatible with other hand-helds and base  
stations in the system. The allowable range for this parameter is between 1 and 40.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Protocol Tab  
Window Delay  
Important: The value assigned to this parameter should not be changed from  
the factory setting without a clear understanding of the timing of  
the radio protocol.  
This parameter specifies the amount of time (in milliseconds) the 7530 G2 should  
add to each response window in order to accommodate the receive/transmit  
switching characteristics of the radio. The value assigned must be compatible with  
other units and base stations in the system. The default setting of 19 is based on the  
requirements of a 2 level modulation narrow band radio, operating at 9600 baud.  
Poll Timeout  
This parameter (in units of 16.6 ms) sets the time-out value used for automatic  
channel switching. “Poll Timeout” is the time during which the 7530 G2 should  
detect at least one poll from a base station. As each “Poll Timeout” passes without a  
successful poll from the base station, the 7530 G2 channel quality decreases. If the  
channel quality falls to below 46%, the unit begins searching for a new channel.  
A value from 1 to 200 can be assigned to this parameter.  
Late TX Limit  
The value entered for this parameter (measured in milliseconds) sets the maximum  
allowable deviation time from the start of a response window during which an  
7530 G2 can make a transmission. After this threshold, the transmission will not be  
attempted and the 7530 G2 will try again at the next opportunity. For example,  
suppose this parameter is set to 5. From the beginning of the response window,  
the 7530 G2 can be up to 5 milliseconds late sending a transmission. Beyond  
this threshold, the transmission is not attempted. The hand-held waits for the  
next opportunity.  
The allowable range for this parameter is from 1 and 10 – the default value is 2.  
Test Polling Values  
Tap on the Test Polling Values button to test the polling values indicated in  
this dialog box without committing them to memory.  
To commit the new polling values to memory:  
Tap on the OK button – the dialog box is closed and the new values  
are saved.  
To discard the new values, and retain the existing values:  
Tap on the X button at the top of the dialog box.  
140 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Power Tab  
5.10.4 Power Tab  
Enable Power Saving  
When this parameter is checked, power saving is enabled.  
Idle Poll Limit  
Note: The “Idle Poll Limit” parameter is only used when “Enable Power Sav-  
ing” is enabled.  
This parameter determines how many transmit opportunities – base station polls  
with available response windows – must be consecutively skipped before the 7530  
G2 places the radio into power-down mode for power saving. The allowable range  
for this parameter is from 1 to 200. The default value is 10.  
Lower values cause the hand-held to enter power saving mode quickly, extending  
battery life but reducing 7530 G2 responsiveness. Higher values increase  
responsiveness but decrease battery life.  
Power Off Time  
This parameter determines the amount of time (in seconds) the 7530 G2 radio stays  
in power-down mode when a power down period has been initiated. “Power Off  
Time” is only used when the “Enable Power Saving” parameter is enabled.  
The allowable range for this parameter is 1 to 60.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Radio Tab  
5.10.5 Radio Tab  
Modulation/Baud Rate  
The options listed in the “Modulation / Baud Rate” dropdown menu are:  
2 Level/4800, 2 Level/9600, 4 Level/9600 and 4 Level/19200. The value assigned  
to this parameter must be identical to the corresponding parameter in the Psion  
Teklogix Base Station. This parameter is stored in the radio’s non-volatile memory.  
The default value for “Modulation/Baud Rate” is 2 Level/9600  
Data Squelch  
“Data Squelch” controls the radio receiver, cutting it off when the signal is too weak  
for reception of anything but noise. Receive Signal Strength Indicator values below  
the “Data Squelch” threshold prevent further processing of the receive signal while  
higher values allow further processing. The allowable range is 0 to 100 with a  
default value of 0.  
In noisy environments, this value can be increased to reject noise. In environments  
with less noise, this value can be decreased to allow the received signal and increase  
range. This parameter is stored in the radio’s non-volatile memory.  
Test Squelch  
Tap on the Test Squelch button to prompt the radio to use the “Data  
Squelch” value without committing it to the radio’s non-volatile memory –  
in other words, to ‘test’ the value assigned to the “Data Squelch” parameter.  
To commit the new “Data Squelch” value to the radio’s non-volatile memory:  
Tap on the OK button – the dialog box is closed and the new value is saved.  
142 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Scanner Settings  
To discard the new value, and keep the old “Data Squelch” value:  
Tap on the X button at the top of the dialog box. The old value is sent to the  
protocol driver.  
Frequency Table  
Tap on the Frequency button to display the Frequency Table dialog box.  
Tap on the Copy “Receive” to “Transmit” button to copy the contents of  
the “Receive” fields into the corresponding “Transmit” fields.  
When you tap on this button, a warning box is displayed asking Copy all the Rx  
frequencies to the Tx frequencies?  
Tap on the Yes button to go ahead or No to stop the copy process.  
Statistics  
Tap this button to display communication statistics.  
Refer to “Statistics Screen” beginning on page 132 for details about this screen.  
Advanced  
This button launches the “Radio Test Application”.  
5.11 Scanner Settings  
The Teklogix Scanners icon in the Control Panel provides dialog boxes in  
which you can tailor bar code options and choose the bar codes your scanner  
will recognize. The parameters are preset with the default settings of the decoded  
scanner installed in the unit.  
If you wish to recover the factory defaults after making changes, the defaults can be  
applied to a selected parameter, sub-tree of parameters, or all scanner parameters.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Bar Codes  
Using the stylus, touching and holding on a symbology will pop up a menu to  
default the sub-tree, or all settings. Touching and holding on an individual setting  
will pop up a menu to default that setting, or all settings.  
Figure 5.31 Teklogix Scanner Icon  
5.11.1 Bar Codes  
Figure 5.32 Scanner Properties  
5.11.1.1 The Scanner  
The dropdown menu to the right of the Scanner option allows you to choose from one  
of the following scanner types used with your hand-held: Non-decoded, Decoded  
(internal), Decoded (Intermec ISCP) and Imager.  
144 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Non-Decoded Scanners  
Note: Your 7530 G2 is configured at the factory for internal scanner types. The  
type of scanner installed can be determined through the System icon in  
the Control Panel, under the System Properties tab.  
Important: To improve the decode speed and performance, enable (set to  
‘on’) only those codes that are required by the application.  
Keep in mind that some bar code types are only available when an internal imaging  
scanner is installed. All internal scanners can be configured using these dialog  
boxes. External, non-decoded scanners are also configured through the Scanner  
Properties dialog box.  
However, external decoded scanners must be configured by scanning special  
configuration bar codes. In these cases, the scanner manufacturer provides  
programming manuals for configuration purposes.  
For Symbol decoded scanners, refer to the LS3408 programming guide.  
®
For PowerScan (PSC) decoded scanners, refer to the Powerscan Program-  
ing Guide (PSC).  
5.11.2 Non-Decoded Scanners  
Tap on the Scanner dropdown menu, and choose Non-decoded.  
All the available bar code symbologies for this type of scanner can be selected in  
this tab.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Non-Decoded Scanners  
A ‘plus’ sign (+) to the left of the menu item indicates that a sub-menu of parameters  
is attached.  
Tap the stylus on the + sign to display the sub-menu.  
To change a parameter value, double-tap on the parameter. If you need to  
type a value, a dialog box is displayed in which you can type a new value.  
If you need to change a yes or no value, double-tapping on the parameter  
toggles between yes and no.  
If you’re using the keyboard:  
Highlight the bar code you want to work with, and press the [RIGHT]  
arrow key to display the sub-menu.  
Use the [UP] and [DOWN] arrow keys to highlight a parameter.  
To change a parameter value, press [SPACE] or the [RIGHT] arrow key. If  
a field requires text entry, a text box is displayed in which you can enter the  
appropriate value.  
5.11.2.1 Non-Decoded Options  
Tap the stylus on the + sign next to Options to display these parameters.  
Dot Time (msec)  
The value selected for “Dot Time (msec)” determines (in milliseconds) how long  
the targeting dot remains on before the scanner switches to a normal scan sweep.  
When you double-tap on this parameter, a dialog box is displayed in which you can  
enter a value from 0 to 3000. A value of 0 (zero) disables the target dot.  
Short Code  
When enabled, this parameter allows scanning of short I 2 of 5 bar codes (2  
characters). When disabled, these short bar codes are rejected.  
Enabling “Short Code” may reduce the robustness of the decoding since the  
hand-held must decode more potential bar codes; it is therefore not recommended  
for general-purpose bar codes with 4 or more characters.  
Verify  
The value entered for this parameter determines the number of correct additional  
decodes required after the initial decode, prior to a bar code being accepted. Higher  
values significantly increase the time it takes to decode a bar code but also improve  
the reliability of the decoded bar code.  
146 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Non-Decoded Scanners  
Security  
This parameter controls the tolerance for decoding edge-to-edge bar codes  
(Code 93, Code 128, UPC/EAN). Lower values have a lower tolerance for  
misreads, but they also increase the time it takes to decode the bar code. The default  
value of 30is generally a good compromise setting.  
5.11.2.2 Code 39  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Code 39” or off to disable it.  
Full Ascii  
If this parameter is enabled, the characters +, %, and / are used as escape  
characters. The combination of an escape character and the next character  
is converted to an equivalent ASCII character.  
Include Check  
If this parameter is enabled, the check digit is included with the decoded bar  
code data.  
AIAG Strip  
If this parameter is enabled, the AIAG data identifier is removed from each decoded  
Code 39 label. The data identifier occurs in the first position next to the Code 39  
start character. It can be a single alphabetic character or a series of numeric digits  
followed by an alphabetic character. This identifier defines the general category or  
specific use of the data contained in the rest of the bar code.  
Note: If your unit is operating with the Psion Teklogix TESS application, this  
parameter should not be used in conjunction with the TESS AIAG feature.  
This is because the hand-held performs the strip function before it pro-  
cesses the data through the AIAG feature; if the prefix is stripped, the data  
is not identified as AIAG.  
Error Accept  
If the “Err Accept” and “AIAG Strip” parameters are enabled, all label data without  
an AIAG identifier character is accepted. If the “Err Accept” parameter is disabled  
and the “AIAG Strip” parameter is enabled, the label data is not accepted.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Non-Decoded Scanners  
Mod Checks  
This parameter allows you to choose the check digit calculated: MOD 43 Check,  
MOD 10 Check or None.  
Double-tap on Mod Checks to display your options.  
Tap on a check digit to highlight it, and tap on OK.  
If you choose None, a check is not executed.  
Field Size/Chars  
Field Size  
The field size is the length of the field after the first character is stripped and  
the prefix and suffix characters are added. If the field size is non-zero, only  
bar codes of that length are passed through.  
Prefix Char  
This character, if non-zero, is added before a successfully decoded bar code. Press  
the key you want to insert in the dialog box attached to this parameter. The  
ASCII/Unicode key value of the keypress is displayed.  
Pressing the [ESC] key in this dialog box resets the data to zero.  
Suffix Char  
Note: The appended character is treated as any other keyboard character.  
For example, if [BKSP] is pressed, the usual action for that key is  
performed. If your unit is operating with the Psion Teklogix ANSI  
emulation application, the hand-held transmits the escape sequence  
associated with the function immediately after the bar code data.  
This character, if non-zero, is added after a successfully decoded bar code. Press the  
key you want to insert in the dialog box attached to this parameter. The  
ASCII/Unicode key value of the keypress is displayed.  
Pressing the [ESC] key in this dialog box resets the data to zero.  
Strip Leading  
This parameter determines the number of characters that will be removed from the  
beginning of the bar code before the prefix character is added.  
Note: For Code 39 bar codes, the “AIAG Strip” is performed before the  
“Strip Leading”.  
148 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Non-Decoded Scanners  
Strip Trailing  
The value entered in this parameter determines the number of characters that will be  
removed from the end of the bar code before the suffix character is added.  
5.11.2.3 Code 128  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Code 128” or off to disable it.  
Include Sym  
Setting “Include Sym” to on causes the group separator(s) and start code contained  
in this type of bar code to be displayed on the screen.  
Note: This option is available only when ‘EAN/UCC 128’ is selected.  
Variations  
When using Code 128, you can choose the bar code variation the scanner will  
recognize. The options available are Standard, UCC 128 and EAN/UCC 128.  
Double-tap on Variations to display a dialog box listing your options.  
Tap on a variation to highlight it, and then tap on OK.  
Standard  
Enable Standard if “Code 128” is desired.  
UCC 128  
UCC 128 is a variation of “Code 128”.  
EAN/UCC 128  
To successfully scan this type of bar code, “EAN/UCC 128” must be enabled.  
“EAN/UCC” bar codes include group separators and start codes.  
Note: If you choose None, a check is not executed.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to the description beginning on page 148 for details.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Non-Decoded Scanners  
5.11.2.4 EAN 13  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “EAN 13” or off to disable it.  
Enable Bookland EAN  
Setting this parameter to ON allows your scanner to recognize Bookland EAN  
bar codes.  
Include Country  
If this parameter is enabled, the country code is included with the decoded bar  
code data.  
Include Check  
If this parameter is enabled, the check digit is included with the decoded bar  
code data.  
Addendum  
Important: Before “Addendum” can take effect, the “Short Code” parameter  
(see page 146) must be enabled.  
An addendum is a separate bar code, supplementary to the main bar code.  
This parameter provides three options: Disabled, Optional and Required.  
Depending on the value chosen for this parameter, an addendum is recognized  
or ignored.  
Double-tap on Addendum to display a dialog box listing your options.  
Highlight an item, and tap on OK.  
When “Addendum” is set to Disabled,the scanner does not recognize an  
addendum. If this parameter is set to Optional,the scanner searches for  
an addendum and if one exists, appends it to the main bar code. When the  
parameter is set to Required,the scanner does not accept the main bar code  
without an addendum.  
Note: Setting ‘Addendum’ to Optional reduces performance. Optional  
should only be selected if at least some of the bar codes being read  
have addendums.  
150 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Non-Decoded Scanners  
Prefix/Suffix  
Prefix Char  
This character, if non-zero, is added before a successfully decoded bar code. Press  
the key you want to insert in the dialog box attached to this parameter. The  
ASCII/Unicode key value of the keypress is displayed.  
Pressing the [ESC] key in this dialog box resets the data to zero.  
Suffix Char  
This character, if non-zero, is added after a successfully decoded bar code. Press the  
key you want to insert in the dialog box attached to this parameter. The  
ASCII/Unicode key value of the keypress is displayed.  
Pressing the [ESC] key in this dialog box resets the data to zero.  
Strip Leading  
This parameter determines the number of characters that will be removed from the  
beginning of the bar code before the prefix character is added.  
Note: The appended character is treated as any other keyboard character. For  
example, if [BKSP] is pressed, the usual action for that key is performed.  
If your hand-held is operating with the Psion Teklogix ANSI emulation  
application, the hand-held transmits the escape sequence associated with  
the function immediately after the bar code data.  
Strip Trailing  
The value entered in this parameter determines the number of characters that will be  
removed from the end of the bar code before the suffix character is added.  
5.11.2.5 EAN 8  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “EAN 8” or off to disable it.  
Include Check  
If this parameter is enabled, the check digit is included with the decoded bar  
code data.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Non-Decoded Scanners  
Addendum  
Important: Before “Addendum” can take effect, the “Short Code” parameter  
(see page 146) must be enabled.  
Refer to “Addendum” on page 150.  
Prefix/Suffix  
See “Prefix/Suffix” beginning on page 151.  
5.11.2.6 UPC A  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “UPC A”.  
Include Number Sys  
If this parameter is enabled, the number system digit is included with the decoded  
bar code data.  
Include Check  
If this parameter is enabled, the check digit will be included with the decoded bar  
code data.  
Addendum  
Important: Before “Addendum” can take effect, the “Short Code” parameter  
(see page 146) must be enabled.  
Refer to “Addendum” on page 150.  
Prefix/Suffix  
Refer to page 151 for details.  
5.11.2.7 UPC E  
Convert to UPC-A  
Setting this parameter to onresults in a non-standard decoding that returns 12 digits  
from the 6 digit UPC E bar code.  
152 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Non-Decoded Scanners  
Include Number Sys  
If this parameter is enabled, the number system digit is included with the decoded  
bar code data.  
Include Check  
When enabled, the check digit is included with the decoded bar code data.  
Addendum  
Important: Before “Addendum” can take effect, the “Short Code” parameter  
(see page 146) must be enabled.  
Refer to “Addendum” on page 150.  
Prefix/Suffix  
Refer to page 151 for details.  
5.11.2.8 Codabar  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Codabar” or off to disable it.  
Strip Start/Stop Chars  
Codabar uses the characters A, B, C, and D as start and stop characters. Thus, the  
first and last digits of a Codabar message must be A, B, C, or D, and the body of the  
message should not contain these characters. Setting this parameter to ON strips the  
start and stop characters from this bar code.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to the description beginning on page 148 for details.  
5.11.2.9 Code 93  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Code 93”.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to the description beginning on page 148 for details.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Non-Decoded Scanners  
5.11.2.10 Code 11  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Code 11”.  
Include Check  
If “Include Check” is enabled, the check digit is included with the decoded bar  
code data.  
Check Digits  
This parameter can be set to None, One Check Digit or Two Check Digits.  
Double-tap on this parameter to display a dialog box listing your options.  
Highlight the check digit you want to use, and tap on OK.  
If this parameter set to One Check Digit, it is assumed that the last digit is a  
check digit.  
If this parameter is set to Two Check Digits, it is assumed that the last two digits are  
check digits.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to the description beginning on page 148 for details.  
5.11.2.11 Interleaved 2 of 5  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Interleaved 2 of 5”.  
Mod 10 Check  
If this parameter is enabled, the “Mod 10” check digit is calculated. This calculation  
is the same as the Code 39 Mod 10 check digit.  
ITF Check  
If this parameter is enabled, the ITF-14/16 Mod10 check digit is calculated.  
Include Check  
If this parameter is enabled, the check digit is included with the decoded bar  
code data.  
154 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Non-Decoded Scanners  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to the description beginning on page 148 for details.  
5.11.2.12 MSI Plessey  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “MSI Plessey”.  
One Check Digit  
If this parameter is enabled, it is assumed that the last digit is a check digit.  
Include Check  
If this parameter is enabled, the check digit is included with the decoded bar  
code data.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to the description beginning on page 148 for details.  
5.11.2.13 Discrete 2 of 5  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Discrete 2 of 5”.  
Mod 10 Check  
If this parameter is enabled, the Mod 10 check digit is calculated. This calculation is  
the same as the Code 39 Mod 10 check digit.  
ITF Check  
If this parameter is enabled, the ITF-14/16 Mod10 check digit is calculated.  
Include Check  
If this parameter is enabled, the check digit is included with the decoded bar  
code data.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to the description beginning on page 148 for details.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Internal) Scanners  
5.11.2.14 IATA 2 of 5  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “IATA 2 of 5”.  
Mod 10 Check  
If this parameter is enabled, the Mod 10 check digit is calculated.  
ITF Check  
If this parameter is enabled, the ITF-14/16 Mod10 check digit is calculated.  
Include Check  
If this parameter is enabled, the check digit is included with the decoded bar  
code data.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to the description beginning on page 148 for details.  
5.11.3 Decoded (Internal) Scanners  
Tap on the Scanner dropdown menu, and choose Decoded (internal).  
156 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Internal) Scanners  
5.11.3.1 Decoded (Internal) Options  
Dot Time (msec) (SE2223 only)  
The value selected for “Dot Time (msec)” determines (in milliseconds) how long  
the targeting dot remains on before the scanner switches to a normal scan sweep.  
When you double-tap on this parameter, a dialog box is displayed in which you can  
enter a value of 0 msec, 200 msec or 400 msec. A value of 0 (zero) disables the  
target dot.  
Aim Duration (SE1224, SE1524, SE1223 only)  
This parameter determines the total time the aiming pattern appears before the  
scanner laser begins sweeping. When you double-tap on this parameter, a dialog box  
is displayed in which you can enter a value from 0 to 30 (0 to 3 sec.). A value of 0  
(zero) disables the aiming-dot.  
Laser On Time  
The value assigned to this parameter determines how long the laser will remain on  
when the scan button or trigger is pressed.  
Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box in which you can enter a  
value between 5 and 99, each number representing 0.1 seconds.  
5.11.3.2 Decoded (Internal) Advanced Options  
Continuous Scan Mode  
Setting this parameter to ‘on’ keeps the laser on and continuously decoding as long  
as the scanner button is pressed and held down.  
Minimum Cancel Time  
The value assigned to this parameter determines the time delay before the scanner is  
turned off, once the scanner trigger or button is released. This gives the scanner a  
minimum amount of time to complete its current decode before the scan is cancelled  
when the user quickly triggers on/off.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Internal) Scanners  
Low Power Timeout  
To extend laser life, you can select the length of time the scanner remains active  
following a successful decode. The scanner wakes from low power mode when a  
bar code is scanned – a successful decode restores normal blinking.  
When you double-tap on this parameter, a dialog box is displayed in which you can  
choose a value of 30 sec, 1 min, 2 min or 3 min.  
Note: This parameter is only used if the Trigger Mode has been set to Continu-  
ous On and the 7530 G2 is mounted in a fixed position; otherwise, ‘Low  
Power Timeout’ is not used.  
Parameter Scanning  
Setting this parameter to on enables decoding of parameter bar codes.  
Linear Security Level  
This parameter allows you to select the security level appropriate for your bar code  
quality. There are four levels of decode security for linear code types (e.g., Code 39,  
Interleaved 2 of 5). Higher security levels should be selected for decreasing levels of  
bar code quality. As security levels increase, the scanner’s decode speed decreases.  
Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box in which you can enter a  
value from 1 to 4.  
“Linear security level 1” specifies that the following code types must be  
successfully read twice before being decoded:  
Code Type  
Length  
Codabar  
All  
MSI Plessey  
D 5 of 5  
4 or less  
8 or less  
8 or less  
I 2 of 5  
“Linear security level 2” specifies that all types of codes must be successfully read  
twice before being decoded.  
158 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Internal) Scanners  
“Linear security level 3” specifies that code types other than the following must be  
successfully read twice before being decoded. The following codes must be read  
three times:  
Code Type  
MSI Plessey  
D 2 of 5  
Length  
4 or less  
8 or less  
8 or less  
I 2 of 5  
“Linear security level 4” requires that all code types be successfully read three times  
before being decoded.  
Bi-Direction Redundancy  
Note: This parameter is only valid if a” Linear Security Level” is enabled.  
When this parameter is enabled, a bar code must be successfully scanned in both  
directions (forward and reverse) before being decoded.  
5.11.3.3 Decoded (Internal) 2D Scanning Options (SE2223 only)  
Scanning Mode  
When you double-tap on this parameter, a dialog box is displayed in which you can  
choose one of the following scanning modes: Smart Raster, Always Raster,  
Programmable Raster, Slab Pattern, Cyclone Pattern or Semi-Omni Pattern.  
Raster Height And Raster Expand Rate  
These parameter determine the laser pattern’s height and rate of expansion.  
Note: These parameters are only used when either Programmable Raster or  
Always Raster is assigned to the “2D Scanning Mode” parameter.  
“2D Raster Height” and “2D Raster Expand Rate” are intended  
for very specific applications and are usually not required for normal  
scanning purposes.  
Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box in which you can enter a  
value from 1to 15.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Internal) Scanners  
5.11.3.4 Decoded (Internal) Data Options  
Transmit Code ID Char  
A code ID character identifies the scanned bar code type. In addition to any single  
character prefix already selected, the code ID character is inserted between the  
prefix and the decoded symbol.  
When you double-tap on this parameter, a dialog box is displayed in which you can  
choose a transmit code: None, AIM or Symbol.  
Scan Data Format  
This parameter allows you to change the scan data transmission format.  
Double-tapping on “Scan Data Format” displays the following options from which  
you can choose a data format: data (as-is), data [S1], data [S2], data [S1][S2],  
[P] data, [P] data [S1], [P] data [S2] and [P] data [S1][S2].  
Prefix [P], Suffix [S1] And Suffix [S2]  
A prefix and/or one or two suffixes may be appended to scan data for use in  
data editing.  
When you double-tap on these parameters, a dialog box is displayed in which you  
can enter a value from 0to 255.  
Delete Char Set ECIs (SE2223 only)  
Setting this parameter to on enables the scanner to delete any escape sequences  
representing Character Set ECIs – Extended Channel Interpretations (also known as  
GLIs) from its buffer before transmission.  
When this parameter is enabled, the scanner transmits data from PDF417 and  
MicroPDF417 bar codes containing Character Set ECIs, even when the ECI  
Protocol is disabled.  
ECI Decoder (SE2223 only)  
Setting this parameter to onenables the scanner to interpret any Extended Channel  
Interpretations (ECIs) supported by the scanner. This parameter has no effect on  
symbols that were not encoded using ECIs.  
If this parameter is set to offand a symbol that was encoded using an ECI escape is  
scanned, the scanner transmits the ECI escape followed by the uninterpreted data.  
160 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Internal) Scanners  
5.11.3.5 Code 39  
Enable  
Setting this parameter to on enables “Code 39”.  
Enable Trioptic Code 39  
Note: “Trioptic Code 39” and “Full ASCII” should not be enabled simulta-  
neously. The scanner does not automatically discriminate between these  
two symbologies.  
Trioptic Code 39 symbols always contain six characters. Setting this parameter to  
onallows this type of symbology to be recognized.  
Convert To Code 32  
Note: “Code 39” must be enabled in order for this parameter to function.  
Setting this parameter to onallows the scanner to convert the bar code from “Code  
39” to “Code 32”.  
Code 32 Prefix  
Note: “Convert to Code 32” must be enabled in order for this parameter to  
function.  
When this parameter is enabled, the prefix character “A” is added to all “Code 32”  
bar codes.  
Set Length L1 And Set Length L2  
Lengths for “Code 39” can be set for Any length, Length within a range, One  
discrete length or Two discrete lengths. The length of a code refers to the number of  
characters (i.e., human readable characters), including check digit(s).  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Internal) Scanners  
Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box labelled Set Code Lengths  
where you can define the code length that will be decoded by your scanner.  
Choosing One discrete length allows you to decode only those codes containing a  
selected length. Choosing Two discrete lengths allows you to decode only those  
codes containing two selected lengths. Length within a range allows you to decode  
a code type within a specified range from 1 to 55.  
Check Digit Verification  
When this parameter is enabled, the integrity of a “Code 39” symbol is checked to  
ensure that it complies with specified algorithms.  
Note: Only those “Code 39” symbols that include a Mod 43 check digit are  
decoded when this parameter is enabled.  
Transmit Check Digit  
If the check digit is to be transmitted with the data, this parameter must to enabled.  
Full ASCII  
If this parameter is enabled, the characters +, %, and / are used as escape characters.  
The combination of an escape character and the next character is converted to an  
equivalent ASCII character.  
Decode Performance (SE2223 only)  
If this parameter is enabled, one of three decode levels can be chosen in the “Decode  
Performance Level” parameter.  
Decode Perf. Level (SE2223 only)  
This parameter provides three levels of decode performance or “aggressiveness” for  
Code 39 symbols. Increasing the performance level reduces the amount of required  
bar code orientation—this is useful when scanning very long and/or truncated bar  
codes. Keep in mind that increased levels reduce decode security.  
162 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Internal) Scanners  
When you double-tap on this parameter, a dialog box is displayed in which you can  
enter a decode performance level of between 1 and 3.  
Note: Keep in mind that this parameter limits scanning to one fixed length.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.3.6 Code 128  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Code 128”.  
Enable UCC/EAN-128  
EAN/UCC bar codes include group separators and start codes. To successfully scan  
this type of bar code, “EAN/UCC 128” must be enabled.  
Enable ISBT 128  
To successfully scan this type of bar code, this option must be set to on.  
Decode Performance (SE2223 only)  
If this parameter is set to on, one of three decode levels assigned to the “Decode  
Performance Level” parameter can be selected.  
Decode Perf. Level (SE2223 only)  
This parameter provides three levels of decode performance or “aggressiveness” for  
Code 128 symbols. Increasing the performance level reduces the amount of required  
bar code orientation—this is useful when scanning very long and/or truncated bar  
codes. Keep in mind that increased levels reduce decode security.  
When you double-tap on this parameter, a dialog box is displayed in which you can  
enter a decode performance level of between 1 and 3.  
Note: Keep in mind that this parameter limits scanning to one fixed length.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Internal) Scanners  
5.11.3.7 EAN 13  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “EAN 13”.  
Prefix/Suffix  
See “Prefix/Suffix” beginning on page 151.  
5.11.3.8 EAN 8  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “EAN 8”.  
EAN-8 Zero Extend  
When this parameter is enabled, five leading zeros are added to decoded EAN-8  
symbols, making them compatible in format to EAN-13 symbols. Disabling this  
parameter returns EAN-8 symbols to their normal format.  
Prefix/Suffix  
See “Prefix/Suffix” beginning on page 151.  
5.11.3.9 UPC A  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “UPC A”.  
UPC-A, Check Digit  
If you enable this parameter, the check digit is included with the decoded bar  
code data.  
UPC-A, Preamble  
When you double-tap on this parameter, a dialog box is displayed where you can  
choose one of three options for lead-in characters for UPC-A symbols transmitted to  
the host device: System Char – system character transmitted with the data, Country  
code and System Char – both the country code (“0” for USA) and system character  
are transmitted with the data or None – no preamble is transmitted. The lead-in  
characters are considered part of the symbol.  
164 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Internal) Scanners  
Prefix/Suffix  
See “Prefix/Suffix” beginning on page 151.  
5.11.3.10 UPC E  
Enabled UPC-E  
Set this parameter to on to allow “UPC E” bar code scans.  
Enabled UPC-E1  
Set this parameter to on to allow “UPC-E1” (zero suppressed) bar code scans.  
UPC-E And UPC-E1 Check Digit  
If you enable one or both of these parameters, a check digit is included with the  
decoded bar code data.  
UPC-E And UPC-E1 Preamble  
When you double-tap on one of these parameters, a dialog box is displayed where  
you can choose one of three options for lead-in characters for UPC-E and UPC-E1  
symbols transmitted to the host device: System Char – system character transmitted  
with the data, Country code and System Char – both the country code (“0” for  
USA) and system character are transmitted with the data or None – no preamble is  
transmitted. The lead-in characters are considered part of the symbol.  
Conv. UPC-E To UPC-A  
This parameter converts UPC-E (zero suppressed) decoded data to UPC-A format  
before transmission. After conversion, data follows UPC-A format and is affected  
by UPC-A programming selections (e.g., Preamble, Check Digit).  
Conv. UPC-E1 To UPC-A  
This parameter converts UPC-E1 (zero suppressed) decoded data to UPC-A format  
before transmission. After conversion, data follows UPC-A format and is affected  
by UPC-A programming selections (e.g., Preamble, Check Digit).  
Prefix/Suffix  
See “Prefix/Suffix” beginning on page 151.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Internal) Scanners  
5.11.3.11 UPC/EAN Shared Settings  
The parameters you set here are a shared across all available UPC and EAN  
bar codes.  
Enable Bookland EAN  
Setting this parameter to on allows your scanner to recognize Bookland EAN  
bar codes.  
Supplementals  
'Supplementals” are additionally appended characters (2 or 5).  
Double-tapping this parameter displays a list of options. If Ignore is chosen,  
UPC/EAN is decoded and the supplemental characters are ignored. If Decode is  
chosen, UPC/EAN symbols are decoded with supplementals. Autodiscriminate  
works in conjunction with the Supp. Redundancy parameter.  
Supp. Redundancy  
With “Autodiscriminate” selected in the “Supplementals” parameter, “Supp.  
Redundancy” adjusts the number of times a symbol without supplementals is  
decoded before transmission.  
When you double-tap on this parameter, a dialog is displayed in which you can enter  
a value between 2 and 20. A value of 5 or above is recommended when  
Autodiscriminate is selected and you are decoding a mix of UPC/EAN symbols with  
and without supplementals.  
Security Level  
This parameter controls the tolerance for decoding edge-to-edge UPC/EAN bar  
codes. Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box in which you can  
choose a level from 0 to 3. Lower values have a lower tolerance for misreads, but  
they also increase the time it takes to decode the bar code.  
Linear Decode (SE2223 only)  
“Linear Decode” applies to code types containing two adjacent blocks (e.g.,  
UPC-A, EAN-8, EAN-13). When enabled (set to on), a bar code is transmitted only  
when both the left and right blocks are successfully decoded within one laser scan.  
This option should be enabled when bar codes are in proximity to each other.  
166 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Internal) Scanners  
2D UPC Half Block Stitching (SE2223 only)  
Setting this parameter to on enables “UPC Half Block Stitching” for the SE 3223  
omnidirectional engine only.  
5.11.3.12 Codabar  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Codabar”.  
Set Length L1 And Set Length L2  
Lengths for “Codabar” can be set for Any length, Length within a range, One  
discrete length or Two discrete lengths. The length of a code refers to the number of  
characters (i.e., human readable characters), including check digit(s).  
Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box labelled Set Code Lengths  
where you can define the code length that will be recognized by your scanner.  
Choosing One discrete length allows you to decode only those codes containing a  
selected length. Choosing Two discrete lengths allows you to decode only those  
codes containing two selected lengths. Length within a range allows you to decode  
a code type within a specified range from 5 to 55.  
CLSI Editing  
When enabled, this parameter strips the start and stop characters and inserts a space  
after the first, fifth, and tenth characters of a 14-character Codabar symbol.  
Note: Symbol length does not include start and stop characters.  
NOTIS Editing  
When enabled, this parameter strips the start and stop characters from decoded  
Codabar symbol.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.3.13 Code 93  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Code 93”.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Internal) Scanners  
Set Length L1 And Set Length L2  
Lengths for “Code 93” can be set for Any length, Length within a range, One  
discrete length or Two discrete lengths. The length of a code refers to the number of  
characters (i.e., human readable characters), including check digit(s).  
Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box labelled Set Code Lengths  
where you can define the code length that will be recognized by your scanner.  
Choosing One discrete length allows you to decode only those codes containing a  
selected length. Choosing Two discrete lengths allows you to decode only those  
codes containing two selected lengths. Length within a range allows you to decode  
a code type within a specified range from 4 to 55.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.3.14 Interleaved 2 of 5  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Interleaved 2 of 5”.  
Set Length L1 And Set Length L2  
Lengths for “Interleaved 2 of 5” can be set for Any length, Length within a range,  
One discrete length or Two discrete lengths. The length of a code refers to the  
number of characters (i.e., human readable characters), including check digit(s).  
Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box labelled Set Code Lengths  
where you can define the code length that will be recognized by your scanner.  
Choosing One discrete length allows you to decode only those codes containing a  
selected length. Choosing Two discrete lengths allows you to decode only those  
codes containing two selected lengths. Length within a range allows you to decode  
a code type within a specified range from 4 to 14.  
Check Digit Verification  
When enabled, this parameter checks the integrity of an I 2 of 5 symbol to ensure it  
complies with a specified algorithm – either USS (Uniform Symbology  
Specification) or OPCC (Optical Product Code Council).  
Transmit Check Digit  
If this parameter is enabled, the check digit is included with the bar code data.  
168 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Internal) Scanners  
Convert To EAN 13  
If this parameter is enabled, an I 2 of 5 bar code is converted to EAN 13.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.3.15 MSI Plessey  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “MSI Plessey”.  
Set Length L1 And Set Length L2  
Lengths for “MSI Plessey” can be set for Any length, Length within a range, One  
discrete length or Two discrete lengths. The length of a code refers to the number of  
characters (i.e., human readable characters), including check digit(s).  
Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box labelled Set Code Lengths  
where you can define the code length that will be recognized by your scanner.  
Choosing One discrete length allows you to decode only those codes containing a  
selected length. Choosing Two discrete lengths allows you to decode only those  
codes containing two selected lengths. Length within a range allows you to decode  
a code type within a specified range from 6 to 55.  
Check Digits  
Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box in which you can choose  
One or Two check digit(s).  
If this parameter is set to One, it is assumed that the last digit is a check digit. If  
“Check Digits” is set to Two, it is assumed that the last two digits are check digits.  
Note: If Twocheck digits is selected, an MSI Plessey “Check Digit Algorithm”  
must also be selected. See page 9-88.  
Transmit Check Digit  
If this parameter is enabled, the check digit is included with the bar code data.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Internal) Scanners  
Check Digit Algorithm  
When the Two MSI Plessey check digits option is selected, an additional  
verification is required to ensure integrity. Double-tapping on this parameter  
displays a dialog box in which you can choose the algorithm to be used: MOD  
10/MOD 11 or MOD 10/MOD 10.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.3.16 Discrete 2 of 5  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Discrete 2 of 5”.  
Set Length L1 And Set Length L2  
Lengths for “Discrete 2 of 5” can be set for Any length, Length within a range, One  
discrete length or Two discrete lengths. The length of a code refers to the number of  
characters (i.e., human readable characters), including check digit(s).  
Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box labelled Set Code Lengths  
where you can define the code length that will be recognized by your scanner.  
Choosing One discrete length allows you to decode only those codes containing a  
selected length. Choosing Two discrete lengths allows you to decode only those  
codes containing two selected lengths. Length within a range allows you to decode  
a code type within a specified range from 1 to 12.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.3.17 2D PDF-417 (SE2223 only)  
Enable  
Setting this parameter to onenables PDF-417 two dimensional (2D) coding.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
170 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Internal) Scanners  
5.11.3.18 2D Micro PDF-417 (SE2223 only)  
Enable  
Setting this parameter to on enables “2D Micro PDF-417” bar code scanning. Micro  
PDF-417 is a multi-row symbology that is useful for applications requiring greater  
area efficiency but lower data capacity than PDF-417.  
Code 128 Emulation  
When this parameter is enabled, the scanner transmits data from certain Micro  
PDF-417 symbols as if it was encoded in Code 128 symbols.  
If Code 128 Emulation is enabled, the following Micro PDF-417 symbols are  
transmitted with one of the following prefixes:  
]C1 if the first codeword is 903-907, 912, 914, 915  
]C2 if the first codeword is 908 or 909  
]C0 if the first codeword is 910 or 911  
If Code 128 Emulation is set to off, the Micro PDF-417 symbols are transmitted  
with one of the following prefixes:  
]L3 if the first codeword is 903-907, 912, 914, 915  
]L4 if the first codeword is 908 or 909  
]L5 if the first codeword is 910 or 911  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.3.19 RSS Code (Reduced Space Symbology)  
Enable  
Setting this parameter to on enables “RSS Code” scanning capability.  
Enable RSS-14 (SE1224, SE2223 and SE1524 only)  
RSS-14 code can be either purely linear or split in half with one half stacked on top  
of the other half. Stacking the code reduces the bar code length, and providing the  
nominal height of the code is maintained, it can be omni-directionally scanned.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Internal) Scanners  
Enable RSS Limited (SE1224, SE2223 and SE1524 only)  
‘RSS-Limited” is restricted, in that it can only encode 14 digit GTINs (global trade  
item number) that begin with either a 0 or a 1. It is not stackable and is not designed  
to be read omni-directionally.  
Enable RSS Expanded (SE1224, SE2223 and SE1524 only)  
‘RSS Expanded” uses the same application identifiers as UCC/EAN-128 codes but  
they can be split into sections and stacked several rows high, reducing the length of  
the symbol, while increasing the capacity of data that can be stored. “RSS  
Expanded” code can be omni-directionally scanned.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.3.20 Composite (SE2223 only)  
Important: To successfully read this type of bar code, the two types of  
symbologies included in a composite bar code must be enabled.  
A composite symbol includes multi-row 2D components making it compatible with  
linear and area CCD scanners along with linear and rastering laser scanners.  
The options available for this parameter represent multi-level components of a  
composite symbol.  
Enable CC-C And Enable CC-AB  
To activate these components, set the parameters to on.  
Enable TLC-39  
This composite component integrates MicroPDF417 with the linear code. Setting  
this parameter to on enables this parameter.  
172 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Intermec ISCP)  
5.11.4 Decoded (Intermec ISCP)  
Tap on the Scanner dropdown menu, and choose Decoded (Intermec ISCP).  
5.11.4.1 Decoded (Intermec) Options  
Laser On Time  
The value assigned to this parameter determines how long the imager will remain on  
when the scan button or trigger is pressed.  
Double-tapping on this parameter displays a dialog box in which you can enter a  
value between 1 and 10 seconds.  
5.11.4.2 Decoded (Intermec) Advanced Options  
Continuous Scan Mode  
Setting this parameter to on keeps the imager on and continuously decoding as long  
as the scanner button is pressed and held down.  
Minimum Cancel Time  
The value assigned to this parameter determines the time delay before the scanner is  
turned off, once the scanner trigger or button is released. This gives the scanner a  
minimum amount of time to complete its current decode before the scan is cancelled  
when the user quickly triggers on/off.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Intermec ISCP)  
Parameter Scanning  
Setting this parameter to on enables decoding of parameter bar codes.  
Same Read Validate  
The data is only transmitted after repeated reads give the same result. The  
value assigned at this parameter determines the number of reads required, from  
0 to 10 times.  
Same Read Timeout  
Prevents the same bar code from being read more than once. The value assigned  
determines after what time period the scanner will timeout, from 0 to 2550 msec.  
Diff Read Timeout  
Prevents unwanted reading of other bar codes on the same label. The value assigned  
determines after what time period the scanner will timeout, from 0 to 2550 msec.  
5.11.4.3 Code 39  
Enable  
Setting this parameter to on enables “Code 39”.  
Full ASCII  
If this parameter is enabled, the characters +, %, and / are used as escape  
characters. The combination of an escape character and the next character  
is converted to an equivalent ASCII character.  
Reading Range  
Determines the reading distance from which a bar code can be successfully scanned.  
The default setting, Extended, allows for increased reading distance.  
Start/Stop Transmit  
Setting this parameter to on enables the transmission of start and stop characters,  
which are usually not transmitted. Code 39 can start and end with either a * or a $  
character (see also next parameter Accepted Start Char).  
174 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Intermec ISCP)  
Accepted Start Char  
This parameter allows the user the option of using one of the two start/stop  
characters or both ($ char, * char, $ and * char).  
Check Digit Verification  
Uses the specified algorithm of the option you've chosen to ensure the integrity of  
the symbol data before transmitting. If the data does not contain that algorithm, the  
data is not transmitted. The available options are: Disabled, MOD 43 Check, French  
CIP, or Italian CIP.  
Notes: French CIP (French pharmaceutical) is only used with bar codes contain-  
ing 7 characters.  
Italian CIP (Italian pharmaceutical) is also known as Code 32. It is trans-  
mitted as a standard Code 39 if checksum is not validated.  
Transmit Check Digit  
If the check digit is to be transmitted with the data, this parameter must be enabled.  
Minimum Length  
Minimum lengths for the bar code can be set from 0 to 255. The length of a code  
refers to the number of characters (i.e., human readable characters), including  
check digit(s).  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.4.4 Code 128  
Enabled  
Setting this parameter to on enables “Code 128”.  
EAN 128  
To successfully scan this type of bar code, EAN 128 must be enabled. “EAN” bar  
codes include group separators and start codes.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Intermec ISCP)  
EAN 128 Identifier  
‘EAN 128 Identifier’ allows the AIM ID " ]C1" for EAN 128 to be transmitted or  
removed. By default, this identifier is transmitted if EAN 128 is enabled.  
GTIN Compliant  
GTIN (global trade item number) processing transmits EAN 128 as the 14-character  
EAN/UCC GTIN. To use GTIN processing, you must activate the EAN 128 symbology.  
Important: When EAN 128 and GTIN processing are both activated, it is not  
possible to read normal EAN 128 Codes.  
FNC1 Conversion  
‘FNC1 Conversion’ allows the embedded FNC1 character to be converted to  
another character for applications that cannot use the default <GS> Group Separator  
or hex (1d).  
Double-tapping on this option displays a dialog box listing the allowable  
range – 0 to 255.  
Enable ISBT 128  
To successfully scan this type of bar code (International Society of Blood  
Transfusion), this option must be set to on. If you enable this type of bar code, Code  
128/EAN 128 is deactivated to avoid any confusion.  
ISBT Concat Transmit  
The codes are not concatenated by default. You need to choose one of the options  
provided for this parameter to send concatenated code. Choosing Only  
Concatenated Codes transmits only concatenated codes—single codes will not be  
transmitted. Choosing Concatenated or Single transmits single codes or  
concatenated codes. If only one code of a pair is read, that code will be transmitted  
as a single code. If both codes in a pair are detected, they will be concatenated  
provided that ISBT Concat Any Pair (see below) is enabled.  
ISBT Concat Any Pair  
Enabling this parameter causes all code pairs that can be, to be concatenated even if  
they do not comply with Section 4.1 of the “ISBT 128 Bar Code Symbology and  
Application Specification for Labeling of Whole Blood and Blood Components”  
(June 2000, Version 1.2.1).  
176 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Intermec ISCP)  
Reading Range  
Determines the reading distance from which a bar code can be successfully scanned.  
The default setting Extended, allows for increased reading distance.  
Check Digit Verification  
Uses the specified algorithm of the option you've chosen to ensure the integrity of  
the symbol data before transmitting. If the data does not contain that algorithm, the  
data is not transmitted. The available options are: Disabled, or French CIP.  
Note: French CIP (French pharmaceutical) is only used with bar codes contain-  
ing 7 characters.  
Minimum Length  
Minimum lengths for the bar code can be set from 0 to 255. The length of a code  
refers to the number of characters (i.e., human readable characters), including  
check digit(s).  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.4.5 EAN 13  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “EAN 13”.  
ISBN Conversion  
When this parameter (International Standard Book Number) is enabled, the first 3  
characters (‘978’) are ignored and the checksum (0.9, ‘X’) is calculated on the  
remaining characters.  
Transmit Check Digit  
If the check digit is to be transmitted with the data, this parameter must be enabled.  
Prefix/Suffix  
See “Prefix/Suffix” beginning on page 151.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Intermec ISCP)  
5.11.4.6 EAN 8  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “EAN 8”.  
Transmit Check Digit  
If the check digit is to be transmitted with the data, this parameter must be enabled.  
Convert To EAN 13  
If this parameter is enabled, an EAN 8 bar code is converted to EAN 13.  
Prefix/Suffix  
See “Prefix/Suffix” beginning on page 151.  
5.11.4.7 UPC A  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “UPC A” bar code scanning recognition.  
Transmit Check Digit  
If the check digit is to be transmitted with the data, this parameter must be enabled.  
Transmit Number System  
If this parameter is enabled, the number system digit is transmitted with the decoded  
bar code data.  
Convert To EAN 13  
If this parameter is enabled, a UPC A bar code is converted to EAN 13.  
Prefix/Suffix  
Refer to page 151 for details.  
5.11.4.8 UPC E  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “UPC E”.  
178 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Intermec ISCP)  
Enable UPC-E1  
Set this parameter to ON to allow “UPC-E1” (zero suppressed) bar code scans.  
Transmit Check Digit  
If the check digit is to be transmitted with the data, this parameter must be enabled.  
Transmit Number System  
If this parameter is enabled, the number system digit is transmitted with the decoded  
bar code data.  
Convert To UPC-A  
This parameter converts UPC E (zero suppressed) decoded data to UPC A format  
before transmission. After conversion, data follows UPC A format and is affected  
by UPC A programming selections (e.g. Check Digit).  
Prefix/Suffix  
Refer to page 151 for details.  
5.11.4.9 UPC/EAN Shared Settings  
The setting assigned to the “Addendum” parameter associated with this option is  
shared across all UPC and EAN bar codes.  
Addendum  
An addendum is a separate bar code, supplementary to the main bar code.  
This parameter provides two options: Not Required but Transmitted if Read or  
Required and Transmitted.  
Double-tap on Addendum to display a dialog box listing your options.  
Highlight an item, and tap on OK.  
When Addendum is set to Not Required but Transmitted if Read, the scanner  
searches for an addendum and if one exists, appends it to the main bar code. When  
the parameter is set to Required and Transmitted, the scanner does not accept the  
main bar code without an addendum.  
Addendum Add-on 2 And Addendum Add-on 5  
Enabling these parameters sets the length of the addendum bar code to either 2 or  
5 characters.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Intermec ISCP)  
Addendum Security  
This parameter defines the security level for Addendum Add-on 2 and Addendum  
Add-on 5. The higher the security level, the lower the decode rate, which can be set  
from 0 to 100.  
GTIN Compliant  
GTIN (global trade item number) processing transmits EAN 128 as the 14-character  
EAN/UCC GTIN. To use GTIN processing, you must activate the EAN 128 symbology.  
Important: When EAN 128 and GTIN processing are both activated, it is not  
possible to read normal EAN 128 Codes.  
Reading Range  
Determines the reading distance from which a bar code can be successfully scanned.  
The default setting Extended, allows for increased reading distance.  
5.11.4.10 Codabar  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Codabar”.  
Start/Stop Transmit  
Codabar can use the following sets of characters as start and stop characters:  
a, b, c, d  
A, B, C, D  
a, b, c, d, /, t, n, *, e  
DC1, DC2, DC3, DC4  
Thus, when a set is chosen, the first and last digits of a Codabar message must be  
one of those characters and the body of the message should not contain these  
characters. Setting this parameter to Not Transmitted strips the start and stop  
characters from this bar code.  
CLSI Library System  
When enabled, spaces are inserted after characters 1, 5, 10 in the 14-character label  
(used in the USA by libraries using the CLSI system).  
180 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Intermec ISCP)  
Check Digit Verification  
When enabled, this parameter checks the integrity of an I 2 of 5 symbol to ensure it  
complies with a specified algorithm: either USS (Uniform Symbology  
Specification) or OPCC (Optical Product Code Council).  
Transmit Check Digit  
If the check digit is to be transmitted with the data, this parameter must be enabled.  
Set Length L1, Set Length L2, And Set Length L3  
Lengths for “Codabar” can be set from 0 to 255. The length of a code refers to the  
number of characters (i.e., human readable characters), including check digit(s).  
Double-tapping on these parameters displays dialog boxes where you can define the  
code length that will be recognized by your scanner.  
Length Mode  
You can choose to set L1 as Minimum Length or L1,L2,L3 as Fixed Length.  
Field Size/Char  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.4.11 Code 93  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Code 93”.  
Minimum Length  
Minimum lengths for the bar code can be set from 0 to 255. The length of a code  
refers to the number of characters (i.e., human readable characters), including  
check digit(s).  
Field Size/Char  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.4.12 Code 11  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Code 11”.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 181  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Intermec ISCP)  
Check Digit Verification  
Uses the specified algorithm of the option you've chosen to ensure the integrity of the  
symbol data before transmitting. If the data does not contain that algorithm, the data  
is not transmitted. The available options are: One Check Digit or Two Check Digits.  
Transmit Check Digit  
If the check digit is to be transmitted with the data, this parameter must be enabled.  
Minimum Length  
Minimum lengths for the bar code can be set from 0 to 255. The length of a code  
refers to the number of characters (i.e., human readable characters), including  
check digit(s).  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.4.13 Interleaved 2 of 5  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Interleaved 2 of 5”.  
Reading Range  
Determines the reading distance from which a bar code can be successfully scanned.  
The default setting Extended, allows for increased reading distance.  
Check Digit Verification  
Uses the specified algorithm of the option you've chosen to ensure the integrity of  
the symbol data before transmitting. If the data does not contain that algorithm, the  
data is not transmitted. The available options are: Disabled, MOD 10 Check, or  
French CIP.  
Note: French CIP (French pharmaceutical) is only used with bar codes contain-  
ing 7 characters.  
Transmit Check Digit  
If the check digit is to be transmitted with the data, this parameter must be enabled.  
182 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Intermec ISCP)  
Set Length L1, Set Length L2, And Set Length L3  
Lengths for “Codabar” can be set from 0 to 255. The length of a code refers to the  
number of characters (i.e., human readable characters), including check digit(s).  
Double-tapping on these parameters displays dialog boxes where you can define the  
code length that will be recognized by your scanner.  
Length Mode  
You can chose to set L1 as Minimum Length or L1,L2,L3 as Fixed Length.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.4.14 Matrix 2 of 5  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to ON to enable “Matrix 2 of 5”.  
Minimum Length  
Minimum lengths for the bar code can be set from 0 to 255. The length of a code  
refers to the number of characters (i.e., human readable characters), including  
check digit(s).  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.4.15 MSI Plessey  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “MSI Plessey”.  
Enable Plessy  
Set this parameter to on to enable the “Plessy” bar code.  
Check Digit Verification  
Uses the specified algorithm of the option you've chosen to ensure the integrity of  
the symbol data before transmitting. If the data does not contain that algorithm, the  
data is not transmitted. The available options are: MOD 10 Check, or Double MOD  
10 Check.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Intermec ISCP)  
Transmit Check Digit  
If the check digit is to be transmitted with the data, this parameter must be enabled.  
Plessy Transmit Check Digit  
If the check digit is to be transmitted with the Plessy data, this parameter must  
be enabled.  
Minimum Length  
Minimum lengths for the bar code can be set from 0 to 255. The length of a code  
refers to the number of characters (i.e., human readable characters), including  
check digit(s).  
Plessy Minimum Length  
Minimum lengths for the Plessy bar code can be set from 0 to 255. The length of a  
code refers to the number of characters (i.e., human readable characters), including  
check digit(s).  
Field Size/Char  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.4.16 Discrete 2 of 5  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Discrete 2 of 5”.  
Standard 2 of 5 Format  
You can choose as the standard format either Identicon (6 start/stop bars) or  
Computer Identics (4 start/stop bars).  
Check Digit Verification  
Uses the specified algorithm of the option you've chosen to ensure the integrity of  
the symbol data before transmitting. If the data does not contain that algorithm, the  
data is not transmitted. The available options are: Disabled, or MOD 10 Check.  
Transmit Check Digit  
If the check digit is to be transmitted with the data, this parameter must be enabled.  
184 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Intermec ISCP)  
Set Length L1, Set Length L2, And Set Length L3  
Lengths for “Codabar” can be set from 0 to 255. The length of a code refers to the  
number of characters (i.e., human readable characters), including check digit(s).  
Double-tapping on these parameters displays dialog boxes where you can define the  
code length that will be recognized by your scanner.  
Length Mode  
You can chose to set L1 as Minimum Length or L1,L2,L3 as Fixed Length.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.4.17 2D PDF-417  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “2D PDF-417”.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.4.18 2D Micro PDF-417  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to ON to enable “2D Micro PDF-417”.  
Code 128 Emulation  
When this parameter is enabled, the scanner transmits data from certain Micro  
PDF-417 symbols as if it was encoded in Code 128 symbols.  
If Code 128 Emulation is enabled, the following Micro PDF-417 symbols are  
transmitted with one of the following prefixes:  
]C1 if the first codeword is 903-907, 912, 914, 915  
]C2 if the first codeword is 908 or 909  
]C0 if the first codeword is 910 or 911  
If Code 128 Emulation is set to OFF, the Micro PDF-417 symbols are transmitted  
with one of the following prefixes:  
]L3 if the first codeword is 903-907, 912, 914, 915  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Decoded (Intermec ISCP)  
]L4 if the first codeword is 908 or 909  
]L5 if the first codeword is 910 or 911  
5.11.4.19 2D Codablock  
Enable Codablock A  
Set this parameter to on to enable Codablock type A.  
Enable Codablock F  
Set this parameter to on to enable Codablock type F.  
Enable RSS-14  
RSS-14 code can be either purely linear or split in half with one half stacked on top  
of the other half. Stacking the code reduces the bar code length, and providing the  
nominal height of the code is maintained, it can be omni-directionally scanned.  
Enable RSS Limited  
‘RSS-Limited” is restricted, in that it can only encode 14 digit GTINs (global trade  
item number) that begin with either a 0 or a 1. It is not stackable and is not designed  
to be read omni-directionally.  
Enable RSS Expanded  
‘RSS Expanded” uses the same application identifiers as UCC/EAN-128 codes but  
they can be split into sections and stacked several rows high, reducing the length of  
the symbol, while increasing the capacity of data that can be stored. “RSS  
Expanded” code can be omni-directionally scanned.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.4.20 Telepen  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to ON to enable “Telepen”.  
Format  
Set the bar code character type to either ASCII or Numeric.  
186 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Imager  
Minimum Length  
Minimum lengths for the bar code can be set from 0 to 255. The length of a code  
refers to the number of characters (i.e., human readable characters), including  
check digit(s).  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.5 Imager  
Tap on the Scanner dropdown menu, and choose Imager.  
5.11.5.1 Imager Options  
TekImager Enabled  
Setting this option to on enables the imager installed in your hand-held.  
Continuous Scan Mode  
Setting this parameter to on keeps image capture active and continuously decoding  
as long as the scanner button is pressed and held down.  
Center Bar Code Only  
Note: This parameter must be disabled when reading Composite bar codes.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Imager  
When more than one bar code is visible in a single snap shot, this parameter allows  
you to specify that only the centre image within the imager framing marker be read.  
When this parameter is set to on, the target dot is pointed at the centre image and  
only that image is returned.  
Max Number Barcodes  
Specifies the maximum number of bar codes the imager attempts to decode in an  
image. A maximum of 6 bar codes can be decoded at one time.  
Barcodes Must Decode  
Specifies the minimum number of bar codes that the imager must decode in order to  
report success.  
Note: This number must be less than the number of bar codes assigned to Max  
Number Barcodes. The driver validates and reassigns the value if necessary.  
Window Width  
This parameter determines the width of the captured image in pixels.  
Note: The driver will validate and reassign the value assigned to this parameter,  
if necessary; the driver will also use the Window Width value to horizon-  
tally center the image in the field of view.  
Window Height  
This parameter determines the height of the captured image in pixels.  
Note: The driver will validate and reassign the value assigned to this parameter,  
if necessary; the driver will also use Window Height value to vertically  
center the image in the field of view.  
Dot Time (msec)  
The value selected for “Dot Time (msec)” determines (in milliseconds) how long  
the targeting dot remains on before the scanner begins capturing images. When you  
double-tap on this parameter, a dialog box is displayed in which you can enter a  
value of between 0 and 3000. A value of 0 disables the target dot.  
188 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Imager  
5.11.5.2 Imager Advanced Options  
Important: Do not adjust the advanced options without first consulting Psion  
Teklogix technical support.  
Default Dev. On Reboot  
The value assigned to this parameter determines whether or not the driver will  
restore the factory defaults to the imager device on the next reboot—that is, a cold  
boot or warm boot.  
Note: The driver will default the imager device on a clean-cold-boot, regardless  
of the value of this parameter.  
Min Scan Duration  
This parameter defines the minimum amount of time in seconds that the imager will  
scan when the trigger is pressed and held down without successful decode.  
Note: The actual scan duration when the trigger is pressed relies on the value  
assigned to Captures Per HW Trigger, below.  
Captures Per HW Trigger  
The value assigned to this parameter determines the number of captures the imager  
device will take while the imager's internal hardware trigger is held down.  
Note: This parameter, together with Min Scan Duration, determines the actual  
scan duration. When the scan trigger is pressed and held down, the driver  
starts a timer based on the value of Min Scan Duration and also sends a  
command to emulate the hardware trigger. When completed, if the time  
has not yet expired, it will send another command to the imager device,  
forcing the imager to flash again using the value assigned to Captures Per  
HW Trigger.  
Auto Exposure  
Important: This parameter value should only be changed by qualified Psion  
Teklogix personnel. It should be left at the default value – ‘on’.  
Setting this parameter to on allows the imager to make automatic gain, integration  
and illumination adjustments based on ambient light before capturing the bar code.  
If the adjustment is insufficient, further adjustments are made automatically before  
another image is captured.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Imager  
Fast Converge  
Note: “Auto Exposure” must be set to ‘on’ in order for this parameter  
to function.  
Keep in mind that while this parameter can improve imager performance,  
“Fast Converge” increases battery power consumption.  
Setting this parameter to on speeds the “Auto Exposure” process. It allows the  
imager to rapidly snap a number of bar code capture attempts while finding ideal  
values for gain, integration and illumination.  
Max Gain, Max Integration And Max Illumination  
Important: These parameter values should only be changed by qualified  
Psion Teklogix personnel.  
These parameters represent internal values used by the 2D imager. The “Auto  
Exposure” parameter automatically adjusts the “Max Gain”, “Max Integration” and  
“Max Illumination” parameters to produce the best bar code read. Keep in mind that  
“Auto Exposure” must be set to on in order for these parameter values to be  
automatically adjusted.  
Double-tapping on any of these parameters displays an associated dialog box in  
which an allowable range is displayed: Max Gain – 357 to 7920, Max Integration –  
0 to 65535, Max Illumination – 0 to 7.  
Decoder Timeout  
The decoder is a set of algorithms that examine the image and attempt to find the bar  
codes, and then turn the pixels into data that the computer can use—this process  
takes time. ‘Decoder Timeout’ limits the amount of time the decoder will spend  
attempting to decode an image, and forces it to stop and grab a new image, which  
will probably be easier to decode.  
Note: When decoding multiple bar codes in one image, the value assigned to  
‘Decoder Timeout’ should be increased to 200ms/extra bar code after the first.  
190 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Imager  
Adaptive Windowing  
Adaptive Windowing is an advanced technique used to speed up bar code  
recognition in certain applications. The ‘Adaptive Windowing’ parameter  
automatically reduces the size of the window to the user-programmed window size  
when it successfully decodes (which reduces decode time the next time it is used),  
but increases it to the full size window (1280x1024 for SX5303) on a failed decode.  
Note: This feature assumes that you have reached an understanding about how  
the device operates in your application, and that, after a learning period,  
operators will get used to using the imager in one particular way. It also  
assumes that a trained operator will usually only have near miss scenarios.  
Constant Illumination  
Constant Illumination is used to reduce the intrusiveness of the device’s illumination  
on the observer. Instead of the illumination turning on and off every time the device  
attempts a decode (2-4 times per second), the illumination stays on from the time the  
trigger is pulled until a decode is successful. This feature is useful in low light  
environments, since it will also reduce the distraction that the illumination can have  
on nearby coworkers.  
5.11.5.3 Code 39  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Code 39”.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.5.4 Code 128  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Code 128.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Imager  
5.11.5.5 UPC/EAN  
This parameter allows you to enable the following UPC (Universal Product Code)  
and EAN (European Article Numbering) bar codes: UPC-A, UPC-E, UPC-E1,  
UPC-8, EAN-13, Bookland EAN-13 and Bookland EAN.  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “UPC/EAN” bar codes.  
Addendum  
Refer to “Addendum” on page 150.  
Prefix/Suffix  
Refer to page 151 for details.  
5.11.5.6 Codabar  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Codabar”.  
Field Size/Char  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.5.7 Code 93  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Code 93”.  
Field Size/Char  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.5.8 Interleaved 2 of 5  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Interleaved 2 of 5”.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
192 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Imager  
5.11.5.9 RSS Code (Reduced Space Symbology)  
Enable  
Setting this parameter to on enables “RSS Code” scanning capability.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.5.10 Postal: Australian  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Postal: Australian”.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.5.11 Postal: Japanese  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Postal: Japanese”.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.5.12 Postal: Korean  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Postal: Korean”.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.5.13 Postal: PlaNET  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Postal: PlaNET”.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Imager  
5.11.5.14 Postal: PostNET  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Postal: PostNET”.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.5.15 Postal: Royal  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Postal: Royal”.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.5.16 2D DataMatrix  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “2D DataMatrix”.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.5.17 2D Maxicode  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “2D Maxicode”.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.5.18 2D PDF-417  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “2D PDF-417”.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
194 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Imager  
5.11.5.19 2D Micro PDF-417  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “2D Micro PDF-417”.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.5.20 2D QR Code  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “2D QR Code”.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.5.21 2D Aztec  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “2D Aztec”.  
Field Size/Chars  
Refer to page 148 for details.  
5.11.5.22 Composite  
A composite symbol includes multi-row 2D components making it compatible with  
linear and area CCD scanners along with linear and rastering laser scanners.  
Enabled  
Set this parameter to on to enable “Composite” bar code scanner.  
Important: To successfully read this type of bar code, the two types of  
symbologies included in the composite must be enabled.  
In addition, “Center Bar Code Only” must be disabled.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Options Tab  
5.11.6 Options Tab  
This tab allows you to tailor the double-click parameters and the display options  
associated with your scanner.  
Double Click Parameters  
Click Time (msec)  
This parameter controls the maximum gap time (in milliseconds) for a double-click.  
If the time between the first and second clicks of the scanner trigger is within this  
time, it is considered a double-click. The allowable range is 0 to 1000. A value of  
zero disables this feature.  
A double-click produces different results depending on whether or not a value is  
assigned in the “Click Data” parameter. When a value is not assigned for the “Click  
Data”, double-clicking the scanner trigger overrides the target dot delay set in the  
“Dot Time” parameter and initiates a normal scan sweep. If a value is assigned for  
the “Click Data” parameter, double-clicking the scanner trigger inserts the “Click  
Data” value rather than initiating a scan.  
Click Data  
For both integrated and external scanners, this parameter determines which  
character is sent to the application installed in your 7530 G2 following a  
double-click. A dialog box appears, asking that you press the key you want to insert.  
The ASCII/Unicode key value of the keypress is displayed.  
Pressing the [ESC] key in this dialog box resets the data to zero.  
196 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Options Tab  
Display Parameters  
Scan Result  
When this parameter is enabled, the type of bar code and the result of the scan  
appear on the screen. Note that this information is only displayed after a successful  
decode and is visible only while the scanner trigger is pressed. When the trigger is  
released, this information is cleared from the screen.  
Scan Indicator  
When this parameter is enabled, the laser warning logo appears on the display  
whenever the scanner is activated.  
Scan Result Time (sec)  
The value assigned to the “Scan Result Time (sec)” parameter determines how long  
the scan results of a successful scan are displayed on the screen. Time is measured in  
seconds, and a value of “0” (zero) disables the parameter. When you choose this  
option, a dialog box appears where you can enter a value.  
Note: To remove the scan result from the screen before the “Result Time” has  
expired, point the scanner away from the bar code and press the trigger.  
Good Scan Beep And Bad Scan Beep  
These parameters determine whether or not the 7530 G2 emits an audible scanner  
‘beep’ when a good (successful) scan or a bad (unsuccessful) scan is performed. Set  
these parameters to either on to enable the beeper or off to disable it.  
Soft Scan Timeout  
This parameter is used by the SDK “Scan” function (soft-scan: starting a scan  
session via the SDK function, instead of a physical user trigger press). The value  
assigned to this parameter determines the soft-scan timeout from 1 to 10 sec.  
(default is 3 sec.).  
Scan Log File  
If this parameter is enabled, the input barcode and the modified/translated output bar  
code are logged in the file \Flash Disk\ScanLog.txt. Keep in mind that if ‘Scan Log  
File’ is enabled, there is a slight performance impact when performing multiple  
scans since the log file is written to persistent storage.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Translations  
5.11.7 Translations  
In the Translation tab, tap on the Add button.  
Input  
This value is compared with the decoded bar code reading. If there is a match, the  
“Output” string replaces the data read from the bar code.  
Output  
If there is a match between the decoded bar code and the corresponding “Input”  
string, the decoded bar code will be translated into the “Output” string. This string  
entry parameter can be null, or it may contain any combination of standard and  
special characters (e.g., function keys, [ENTER], etc.).  
198 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Ports  
Type  
The value chosen from this dropdown menu determines what is compared with  
the decoded bar code reading – the beginning of decoded bar code, the end of  
decoded bar code, the entire decoded bar code or anywhere within the decoded bar  
code (default).  
5.11.8 Ports  
While you cannot configure the scanner, you can configure communications with a  
serial decoded scanner using the options in this tab.  
Use these settings to ensure that the communication ports on the 7530 G2 match the  
settings of the serial devices to which they are connected. If the settings do not  
match exactly, the devices may not function. Note that some devices can auto-detect  
serial port settings (such as baud rate), and in this case the 7530 G2 will dictate the  
settings. Baud rates often have a direct impact on performance – they should be set  
as high as possible while still ensuring reliable communication.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Ports  
5.11.8.1 Tether Port (COM1)  
Note: RS232 serial communications is one of the modes available on the tether  
port, located on the side of the 7530 G2  
Baud  
Double-tapping on this parameter displays a pop-up window in which you can  
choose an appropriate baud rate.  
Data Bits  
This parameter determines the number of bits data bits included in each  
asynchronous data byte. Most devices use 8 bit data bytes. Double-tapping on this  
option displays a pop-up window in which you can choose either 7 or 8 data bits.  
200 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Ports  
Parity  
This parameter determines the type of parity checking used on the data going  
through the tether port. Double-tapping on this option displays a pop-up window in  
which you can choose the appropriate Parity.  
Stop Bits  
This parameter specifies the number of stop bits – 1, 1.5 or 2 – used for asynchro-  
nous communication.  
5.11.8.2 Console Port (COM3)  
Note: The console port is accessed via the docking connector on the bottom of  
the 7530 G2. Only the Portable Docking Module (PDM) provides access  
to the console port through a DE-9 interface.  
Enabled  
This parameter must be set to on in order for the 7530 G2 to recognize the device  
connected to the console port.  
Baud  
Refer to page 200 for details.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Ports  
Data Bits  
Refer to page 200 for details about this parameter.  
Parity  
For details, refer to page 201.  
Stop Bits  
Refer to page 201 for details about “Stop Bits”.  
5.11.8.3 Port Replicator Tether (COM6)  
The port replicator tether is a duplicate tether port located on the port replicator  
module of 7530 G2 cradles.  
Baud  
Refer to page 200 for details.  
Data Bits  
Refer to page 200 for details about this parameter.  
Parity  
For details, refer to page 201.  
Stop Bits  
Refer to page 201 for details about “Stop Bits”.  
202 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Ports  
5.11.8.4 Port Replicator Port A (COM5)  
Port replicator Port A is the standard RS232 DE-9 DTE port on the 7530 G2 port  
replicator module available on certain cradle types.  
Enabled  
This parameter must be set to on in order for the 7530 G2 to recognize the device  
connected to the port replicator RS232 DE-9 port (port A).  
Baud  
Refer to page 200 for details.  
Data Bits  
Refer to page 200 for details about this parameter.  
Parity  
For details, refer to page 201.  
Stop Bits  
Refer to page 201 for details about “Stop Bits”.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 5: Configuration  
SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) Setup  
5.12 SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol) Setup  
Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) is the protocol used to monitor and  
manage devices attached to a TCP/IP network (providing they support SNMP).  
SNMP uses Management Information Bases (MIBs) that define the variables an  
SNMP Network Management Station can access. Each product has a defined set of  
MIBs that determine how SNMP operates, the type of access allowed and so on.  
All Psion Teklogix products support the TEKLOGIX-GENERIC-MIB – a MIB that  
defines some common features across Psion Teklogix products. All devices also  
support MIB-II, a management information base that defines the common features  
of TCP/IP networks. The SNMP Agent software embedded in the 7530 G2 product  
supports SNMPv1 (RFC 1157).  
In the Control Panel, tap on the SNMP icon.  
Figure 5.33 SNMP Icon  
204 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Contact Tab  
5.12.1 Contact Tab  
5.12.1.1 Contact  
This field identifies the contact person for this managed node along with  
information about how to get in touch with this person. The content of this  
parameter is accessible through MIB-II’s sysContact object.  
5.12.1.2 Location  
This parameter is used to identify the physical location of this node (e.g., Warehouse  
A: Pillar 32B). The content of this parameter is accessible through MIB-II’s  
sysLocation object.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Communities Tab  
5.12.2 Communities Tab  
The “Communities” tab provides a means of limiting access to SNMP managed  
devices to those SNMP Managers with matching “community names”, as specified  
by RFC 1157.  
Enable SNMP  
Enabling Enable SNMP allows the device to respond to SNMP queries and to send  
Traps. After enabling this option and rebooting the device, the SNMP Agent will  
automatically start up. To disable this feature, remove the check mark from the  
check box.  
5.12.2.1 Adding A Community  
Tap on the Add button to add a new ‘community’.  
206 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Communities Tab  
Name  
The value assigned here is the name assigned by the network administrator to the set  
of devices to which this managed node belongs.  
Rights  
This menu allows you to specify access – that is, ‘Read-Only’ or Read-Write’  
5.12.2.2 Modifying A Community Setting  
To modify an existing community:  
Highlight the community you want to alter.  
Tap on the Change button.  
A Modify Community dialog box is displayed, listing the community you  
highlighted.  
Edit the Name and/or Rights, and press [ENTER] to save your changes.  
5.12.2.3 Removing An Existing Community  
To remove an item:  
Highlight the community you want to remove in the Communities tab and  
then tap on the Remove button.  
A Delete Confirmation screen is displayed.  
To remove a community, tap on the Yes button, or  
If you decide not to remove the community, tap on No.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Trap Destination Tab  
5.12.3 Trap Destination Tab  
A trap is an unsolicited report sent to SNMP Managers by the SNMP Agent running  
on the managed node. This option allows you to define where the report will be sent.  
5.12.3.1 Enabling Authentication TRAPS  
Enabling Enable Authentication TRAPS allows authorization traps to be sent when  
a failure is detected (e.g., an SNMP message received with a bad community name).  
5.12.3.2 Adding A Destination  
To add a new destination:  
Tap on the Add button.  
Type a destination in the text box provided, and press [ENTER].  
208 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Trap Destination Tab  
5.12.3.3 Changing A Destination  
To change an existing trap destination:  
Highlight the destination you want to alter in the Trap Destination tab, and  
then tap on the Change button.  
A dialog box like the one displayed when you add a destination is displayed.  
Make the changes to the destination, and press [ENTER] to save  
the changes.  
5.12.3.4 Removing A Trap Destination  
To remove a trap destination:  
In the Trap Destination tab, highlight the destination you want to delete.  
Tap on the Remove button.  
A Delete Confirmation screen is displayed.  
To remove a destination, tap on the Yes button, or  
If you decide not to remove the destination, tap on No.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 209  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Permitted Hosts Tab  
5.12.4 Permitted Hosts Tab  
For security reasons, the Network Administrator may want to restrict SNMP-node  
access to a known sub-set of SNMP Managers. This tab lists the IP addresses of all  
the SNMP Managers which are allowed to monitor and manage this device. If no  
entries are listed, the device will accept SNMP queries from any host.  
5.12.4.1 Adding A Host  
To add a new host:  
Tap on the Add button.  
Type a new host IP address in the text box provided, and press [ENTER].  
210 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 5: Configuration  
Permitted Hosts Tab  
5.12.4.2 Changing A Host  
To change an existing host IP address:  
Highlight the IP address you want to alter in the Permitted Hosts tab, and  
then tap on the Change button.  
A dialog box like the one displayed when you add a host is displayed.  
Make the necessary changes, and press [ENTER].  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 211  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6.7.2 Using The Combo Dock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .222  
6.7.3 Network Access. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .222  
6.7.4 Troubleshooting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .222  
6.8 Quad Dock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223  
6.8.1 Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223  
6.8.2 Indicators And Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223  
6.8.3 Using The Quad Dock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 213  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
6.8.4.1 Network Addressing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224  
6.11.3 Using The Picker Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230  
6.11.4 Maintaining The Picker Cradle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230  
6.11.5 Powered Cradle Installation In High Voltage Vehicles . . . . . . 231  
6.11.6 Powered Cradle Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231  
6.11.6.1 Wiring Vehicle Power To The Cradle. . . . . . . . . . . 232  
6.11.7 The Port Replicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233  
6.12 Tether Adaptor Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234  
214 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
External Bar Code Readers  
6.1 External Bar Code Readers  
6.1.1 PowerScan™ Standard, LR and XLR Bar Code Scanners  
The 7530 G2 supports Psion Teklogix’ PowerScan™ industrial bar code scanner  
with standard, long range and extra long range options.  
To connect this scanner to the 7530 G2, attach the device to the tether port at the  
upper-right side of the 7530 G2. Review your “PowerScan Programing Guide  
(PSC)” before you begin.  
6.1.2 Entering Data With The Bar Code Reader  
Note: For helpful scanning tips, refer to “Scanning Techniques” on page 49.  
When a label is scanned successfully, the 7530 G2 will beep if configured  
appropriately and the scan LED will flash. Occasionally, the bar code labels are  
poorly printed or damaged and cannot be read properly. In this case, use the  
keyboard to enter data from the label.  
6.2 RD7950 Integrated UHF RFID Reader  
Note: This RFID reader is scheduled for future release.  
The RD7950 UHF RFID Reader is an EPC-compliant RFID reader available for  
Psion Teklogix rugged hand-held computing devices. Multimedia data capture  
capabilities are delivered by combining RFID with existing technologies such as  
laser bar code scanning or imaging.  
Note: Battery specifications are detailed beginning on page 247.  
7530 G2s operate with Lithium-Ion batteries – either a 1900 mAh battery pack or a  
high capacity, 2400 mAh battery.  
Important: It is critical that the battery safety information described on  
page XII near the beginning of this manual be reviewed carefully  
and that all warnings be strictly followed.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 215  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
Battery Charging  
6.4 Battery Charging  
Note: Initially, new batteries that have been fully charged may indicate slightly  
less than 100% charge. No special conditioning is required. The full  
capacity of the battery will reach 100% after 5 cycles through the charger.  
It can take from 1.5 to 4 hours to charge a battery. The 7530 G2’s intelligent  
charging system protects the battery from over-charging by terminating the charge  
process when the battery is at maximum capacity.  
Important: To preserve battery integrity, the charger will proceed with a  
charge only when the battery temperature falls between 5° C and  
battery status LED flashes yellow and the charge is suspended.  
6.5 Gang Charger  
The gang charger is designed to charge up to six 7530 G2 Lithium-Ion batteries at  
one time. Your charger is shipped with the appropriate IEC mains power cord. If the  
supplied power cord is incorrect for your country, contact Psion Teklogix for  
assistance (see Appendix A: Support Services And Worldwide Offices).  
Note: The gang charger is shipped with a user manual. It is critical that this  
manual be reviewed for additional information and updates.  
6.5.1 Installation  
The gang charger can be wall mounted using the wall mount kit, Model # HU3106,  
or it can be operated on a flat surface. Install the charger in an area that is free from  
excessive dirt, dust and contaminants. The ambient temperature must be in the range  
5° C to 39° C (41° F to 102° F). The charger will not charge batteries outside  
of this temperature range. For maximum performance, it is recommended that  
the charger be operated at room temperature – a temperature range between  
18° C to 25° C (64° F to 77° F).  
The charger can consume up to 2A @ 120VAC or 1A @ 240VAC. Check to ensure  
the mains circuit supplying the charger is adequate for this loading (especially if  
several chargers are being powered from the same circuit).  
After unpacking the unit:  
Visually check the charger for damage.  
Install the IEC power cord and apply power.  
216 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
Operator Controls  
A green indicator in the lower-right lights to indicate power is present. All charge  
indicators flash momentarily at powerup to indicate that the charger is ready for  
operation.  
If you choose to wall mount the charger, follow the instructions packaged with the  
mounting bracket kit. Be sure to locate the charger in an area where there is no risk  
of injury to persons walking in the vicinity.  
6.5.2 Operator Controls  
The gang charger does not have operator controls or a power switch.  
6.5.3 Charge Indicators  
Each battery charge slot is equipped with a tri-coloured LED to indicate the charge  
status of the battery. When 7530 G2 batteries are inserted in the charger, the colour  
and behaviour of the LEDs associated with the charge wells in use indicate the  
status of the charge.  
LED Behaviour  
Off  
Icon  
Charge Status  
No battery detected in the slot.  
Battery is fully charged.  
Solid green  
Flashing green  
Solid yellow  
Battery is charged to 75% capacity.  
Charge in progress.  
Battery temperature out of charge range between 5° C  
to 39° C (41° F to 102° F). This icon indicates that the  
charger is waiting to charge. Charging is attempted  
every five minutes until the battery is within the  
appropriate temperature range.  
Flashing  
yellow  
Battery rejected (at insertion) or unable to complete  
charge on battery  
Solid red  
Charging circuit problem. Refer to “Troubleshooting”  
on page 218.  
Flashing red  
Table 6.1 Gang Charger Indicators  
6.5.4 Charging Batteries  
Install the battery with the battery contacts facing the charger. Slide the  
battery between the guide rails until it lightly latches in place.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 217  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
Troubleshooting  
The LED directly below the slot in which a battery is inserted lights up immediately.  
A solid yellow LED indicates that the battery is being charged. If the battery  
temperature is outside 5° C to 39° C (41° F to 102° F), the LED flashes yellow until the  
temperature is acceptable. A fully discharged battery will normally take between 1.5  
and 4 hours to charge. When the battery charge reaches 75%, the indicator flashes  
green. At full capacity, it turns solid green.  
When the battery is fully charged, the charger stops applying power; the battery  
cannot be overcharged if left in the charger slot. The 75% charge indicator is handy  
if you need a quick recharge – it often occurs after less than an hour.  
6.5.5 Troubleshooting  
6.5.5.1 Excessive Charge Duration  
The charger is equipped with a recalibration function – a function that fully  
discharges and then fully recharges the battery. This process is necessary to  
recalibrate the battery capacity gauge internal to the battery. The charger attempts  
recalibration when:  
the battery capacity is at less than 30%, and  
the battery has undergone more than 40 partial charge cycles since the last  
full discharge.  
A complete battery discharge takes between 1.5 and 4 hours to complete. When in  
discharge mode, the LED indicator flashes yellow. The recalibration function  
extends the charge time by up to 2 hours.  
6.5.5.2 Indicator Flashing Red  
If the indicator flashes red:  
Remove all batteries and disconnect the mains power cable.  
Wait at least 20 seconds, and then plug the cable in again.  
If any of the charge slot LEDs continue to flash red, the charger is defective and  
requires service. If all indicators are flashing red, there is a power supply problem  
and the charger requires service.  
218 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
Power LED Does Not Light Up  
6.5.5.3 Power LED Does Not Light Up  
Remove all batteries, and unplug the charger.  
Connect another device to the mains outlet to ensure there is power.  
Remove the IEC mains power cable from the charger, and check it for  
damage.  
Reconnect the mains cable in the charger and mains outlet.  
If the power LED still does not light up:  
Unplug the mains cable, and check the fuse at the rear of the charger.  
If the fuse appears to be intact, the charger requires service.  
6.5.5.4 Indicator Does Not Light When Battery Installed  
Remove the battery, and clean the contacts on the battery and the  
charge slot.  
Reinstall the battery, and check that it is fully seated in the slot.  
Inspect the charge slot contacts for damage (are they bent, flattened, twisted  
or broken).  
Try inserting a battery that you know to be working in the charger slot.  
Reconnect the mains power cable, and check that the slot indicator flashes  
at powerup.  
6.6 Combo Charger  
The 7530 G2 combo charger is a desktop charger designed to charge the 7530 G2  
internal battery along with a spare battery pack. The combo charger provides  
sufficient power to operate and fast charge the 7530 G2 internal battery, while  
recharging the spare battery pack.  
Note: The combo charger is shipped with a user manual. It is critical that this  
manual be reviewed for additional information and updates.  
6.6.1 Installation  
Keep the combo charger away from excessive dirt, dust and contaminants. The  
combo charger will not charge batteries outside an ambient temperature range of  
5° C to 39° C (41° F to 102° F). It is recommended that this charger be operated at  
room temperature – between 18° C and 25° C (64° F to 77° F) for maximum  
performance.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 219  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
Operator Controls  
After unpacking the unit:  
Visually inspect the charger for possible damage.  
Install the IEC power cord and apply power.  
A green LED in the lower-right corner of the front panel lights to indicate that  
power is present. The charge LED flashes momentarily at powerup. The charger is  
now ready for operation.  
6.6.2 Operator Controls  
The combo charger has no operator controls or power switch.  
6.6.3 Using the Combo Charger With The 7530 G2  
Gently slide the 7530 G2 into the cradle portion of the combo charger until  
lightly latched. An icon is displayed indicating that the 7530 G2 is properly  
installed in the combo charger –  
.
The battery charge LED on the 7530 G2 lights up indicating that the unit has  
external power and battery charging may begin. It is safe to leave the 7530 G2 in the  
combo charger cradle while it is not in use – the battery will not be overcharged.  
6.6.4 Charging The Spare Battery  
Install the battery with the latch facing towards the rear of the charger –  
slide it between the guide rails until it lightly latches in place.  
The LED for the slot lights up immediately. A solid yellow LED indicates the  
battery is being charged. A flashing yellow LED indicates that the battery  
temperature is outside the acceptable charge range – between 5° C and 39° C  
(41° F to 102° F).  
A fully discharged battery normally takes between 1.5 and 4 hours to charge. When  
the battery capacity reaches 75%, the LED flashes green. When the battery is at full  
capacity, the indicator turns solid green.  
The combo charger stops applying power to the battery when it is fully charged –  
there is no risk of overcharge if the battery remains in the charge slot. The 75%  
charge indicator is handy if you need a quick recharge – a quick charge often takes  
less than one hour.  
220 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
Charge Indicators  
6.6.5 Charge Indicators  
The spare battery charge slot has an associated tri-colour LED indicator on the  
lower-right area of the front panel.  
LED Behaviour  
Charge Status  
Off  
No battery detected in the slot.  
Solid green  
Battery is fully charged.  
Battery is charged to 75% capacity.  
Charge in progress.  
Flashing green  
Solid yellow  
Battery temperature outside the charge range of between  
5° C to 39° C (41° F to 102° F). Charging is attempted  
every five minutes until the battery is within the appropriate  
temperature range.  
Flashing yellow  
Battery rejected (at insertion) or unable to complete charge  
Solid red  
Charging circuit problem. Refer to “Troubleshooting” on  
page 218 for details.  
Flashing red  
Table 6.2 Combo Charger Indicators  
The combo charger supplies DC power to enable the 7530 G2 internal fast charger.  
Charge status is displayed on the 7530 G2 charge LED – the lower-right LED. Refer  
Normally, it takes from 1.5 to 4.0 hours to fully charge the 7530 G2 internal battery.  
Note: Battery charging continues whether the 7530 G2 is switched on or off.  
6.6.6 Troubleshooting  
The gang charger troubleshooting section also applies to the combo charger. Refer  
to “Troubleshooting” on page 218, for helpful tips.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 221  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
Combo Dock  
The combo dock is identical to the combo charger with one exception – the combo  
dock is equipped with a 10/100 BaseT Ethernet interface. The charging information  
in “Combo Charger” beginning on page 219 also applies to the combo dock.  
6.7.1 Installation  
Refer to the “Installation” guidelines for the combo charger beginning on page 219.  
Attach a CAT5 RJ45 network patch cable (shipped with the combo dock)  
between your network and the RJ45 jack on the rear of the dock.  
A green LED is illuminated next to the RJ45 connector when a valid network link is  
established.  
A user application needs to be loaded onto each 7530 G2 that utilizes the combo  
dock for communication. With the network connected and this application loaded,  
the combo dock is ready for use.  
6.7.2 Using The Combo Dock  
Gently slide the 7530 G2 into the cradle portion of the combo dock until  
lightly latched. The 7530 G2 detects combo dock and displays the appropri-  
ate icon –  
.
The battery charge LED (lower-right LED) on the 7530 G2 lights up to show it has  
external power and may start charging the battery.  
Interaction with the 7530 G2 while in the combo dock is a function of the user  
application software used to communicate with the host network.  
6.7.3 Network Access  
The combo dock includes a dedicated USB to Ethernet converter. This USB  
converter appears as a USB slave to the 7530 G2 USB host controller. The 7530 G2  
automatically detects insertion into a combo dock and loads the appropriate drivers  
to communicate with the USB/Ethernet converter.  
See “Network Addressing” on page 224 for details about network addressing issues  
with the combo dock.  
6.7.4 Troubleshooting  
Troubleshooting issues for the combo dock are identical to those of the quad dock.  
Refer to “Troubleshooting” on page 224 for helpful tips.  
222 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
Quad Dock  
6.8 Quad Dock  
Note: The quad dock is shipped with a user manual. It is critical that this man-  
ual be reviewed for additional information and updates.  
The Quad Dock permits each of four docked 7530 G2 hand-helds to communicate  
with a 10/100 BaseT Ethernet network at greater than 2Mbps. It also provides  
sufficient power to operate and fast charge the batteries in the 7530 G2s.  
6.8.1 Installation  
The quad dock should be located away from excessive dirt, dust and contaminants.  
The ambient temperature must fall between 5° C to 39 °C (41° F to 102° F). The  
7530 G2 internal charger will not charge batteries outside of this temperature range.  
For maximum performance, it is recommended that the quad dock be operated at  
room temperature – from 18° C to 25° C (64° F to 77° F).  
The quad dock can consume up to 3A @ 120VAC or 1.5A @ 240VAC. Ensure that  
the mains circuit supplying the unit is adequate, especially if several docks are being  
powered from the same circuit.  
After unpacking the unit:  
Visually inspect the unit for any damage.  
Install the IEC power cord and apply power.  
A green indicator in the lower-right corner of the front panel lights up to indicate  
that power is present.  
Attach a CAT5 RJ45 network patch cable (supplied) between your network  
and the RJ45 jack on the rear of the dock.  
A green LED is illuminated next to the RJ45 connector when a valid network link is  
established.  
A user application must be loaded onto each 7530 G2 that utilizes the quad dock for  
communication. When the network is connected and this application is loaded, the  
quad dock is ready for use.  
6.8.2 Indicators And Controls  
The quad dock has no user controls. It is equipped with a power indicator LED and  
RJ45 link and traffic indicator LEDs. When a valid network link is established, a  
green LED is illuminated next to the RJ45 connector.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 223  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
Using The Quad Dock  
6.8.3 Using The Quad Dock  
Gently slide the 7530 G2 into the cradle portion of the quad dock until  
lightly latched.  
The 7530 G2 detects that it is in a quad dock and displays the appropriate icon in the  
taskbar – . The battery charge LED on the 7530 G2 lights up to show it has  
external power and may start charging the battery.  
Interaction with the 7530 G2 while in the quad dock is a function of the user  
application software used to communicate with the host network.  
6.8.4 Network Access  
The quad dock includes a four port 10/100 Ethernet hub. Each of the four  
downstream ports are connected to dedicated USB-to-Ethernet converters. These  
USB converters appear as USB slaves to the 7530 G2 USB host controller. The  
7530 G2 automatically detects insertion into a quad dock and loads the appropriate  
drivers to communicate with the USB/Ethernet converters.  
6.8.4.1 Network Addressing  
Although the USB converters have fixed Ethernet MAC addresses, there is  
generally no correlation between these addresses and a specific 7530 G2 hand-held.  
The host application uses standard TCP/IP protocol to name, locate and  
communicate with a specific 7530 G2 on the network.  
If a link is established between a hand-held and a host, the application on the host  
and on the 7530 G2 must have a recovery mechanism in the event that the hand-held  
is removed from the dock and the link is interrupted.  
6.8.5 Battery Charging  
The quad dock supplies DC power to enable the 7530 G2 internal fast charger.  
Charge status is displayed on the hand-held charge LED (see “Charge LED” on  
page 43). Battery charging continues whether the unit is switched on or off.  
Normally, it takes between 1.5 and 4 hours to fully charge the 7530 G2 internal  
battery.  
6.8.6 Troubleshooting  
The indicators, applications and drivers required to use and monitor the docking  
station are installed on the 7530 G2 – no indicators or applications are present on the  
docking station itself.  
224 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
Network Link Unsuccessful  
6.8.6.1 Network Link Unsuccessful  
If a network link fails, the 7530 G2 application alerts the operator that the link was  
unsuccessful.  
6.8.6.2 7530 G2 LED Does Not Light When Docked  
Check that the quad dock has power – is the Power LED on the quad  
dock illuminated?  
Try inserting the 7530 G2 in another slot in the quad dock.  
Check for dirt or contamination on the docking contacts at the bottom of the  
7530 G2. Wipe the contacts with a damp cloth if necessary.  
Check the pogo pins inside the dock cradle for dirt. Gently wipe with a  
damp cloth if they appear to be dirty or discoloured.  
Check that the pogo pins are not bent or damaged.  
Remove and reinsert the 7530 G2 in the cradle, and check that the latch is  
holding the unit in place (the pogo pins must be compressed for proper  
contact).  
Make certain that the battery installed in the 7530 G2 is not defective.  
6.9 Portable Docking Module (PDM)  
Warning:  
The mains power cord for the DC adapter shall comply with  
national safety regulations of the country where the equipment  
is to be sold.  
The Portable Docking Module (PDM) clips onto the base of the 7530 G2 and is  
most often used to charge the 7530 G2 battery when a desktop charger is not  
convenient. The PDM also offers additional communication ports, making it useful  
for upgrading software in the 7530 G2 from a USB-equipped laptop computer.  
Figure 6.2 on page 227 illustrates the connectors on the PDM.  
Align the pins on the PDM with the connectors on the base of the 7530 G2.  
Gently snap the PDM into place on the base of the unit. Figure 6.1 on  
page 226 provides a visual representation of how to secure the PDM.  
Note: The latching mechanism on the PDM is designed for quick installation  
and release. It is not meant for heavy duty use.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 225  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
Portable Docking Module (PDM)  
Psion Teklogix recommends using a powered cradle or combo charger in  
harsh environments.  
Align the guide pins on the PDM with the  
slots on the base of the 7530 G2, and  
gently snap the PDM onto the hand-held.  
Guide Pins  
Figure 6.1 Attaching The PDM To The Base Of The 7530 G2  
226 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
Portable Docking Module (PDM)  
Type B USB Device  
RS232 Serial Port  
Type A USB Host  
15 VDC Power Jack  
Figure 6.2 PDM Ports And Connectors  
The interfaces available on the PDM are as follows:  
DC power jack (15VDC @ 2.5A)  
Type A USB host port (for connection to USB devices such as a mouse,  
keyboard, printer, etc.)  
Type B USB device port (for connection to a USB host such as a PC)  
RS232D DE9 serial port (for connection to a PC COM port or a serial  
device such as a printer)  
The standard Psion Teklogix PDM kit (PN HU4001) includes the necessary DC  
power supply, USB cables and RS232D 9-pin cable.  
Use only the recommended adaptor with the PDM – it includes transient  
suppressors that protect your 7530 G2 from damage.  
The PDM contains reverse polarity and over voltage protection. If the DC power  
jack is wired backwards or exceeds 20VDC, the PDM shuts down to protect the  
7530 G2, the PDM and the power supply from damage. Psion Teklogix does not  
recommend substituting the DC power supply provided with your PDM.  
The DC power supplied by the PDM is sufficient to operate the 7530 G2 and fast  
charge its internal battery at the same time. The 7530 G2 can run from a PDM  
without a battery installed.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 227  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
Bluetooth Peripherals  
6.10 Bluetooth Peripherals  
If the 7530 G2 is equipped with a Bluetooth radio, it is possible to communicate  
with a variety of Bluetooth peripherals, including GSM/GPRS handsets, scanners,  
printers, and so on. The range of the Bluetooth radio in the 7530 G2 is limited to  
approximately 10 meters (32 feet). The Bluetooth antenna is located behind the  
scanner ‘bulge’ on the back of the hand-held.  
Psion Teklogix provides built-in support for the Bluetooth peripherals listed below.  
Psion Teklogix provides built-in support for:  
Bluetooth-equipped cell phone.  
Serial Port Profile (SPP).  
Dial-up Networking Profile (DUN).  
File Transfer Profile (FTP).  
Human Interface Device (HID).  
LAN Access Profile (LAP).  
Object Push Profile (OPP).  
Keep in mind that Bluetooth and IEEE 802.11g radios both operate in the 2.4GHz  
band. Although the 7530 G2 includes features to minimize interference,  
performance of the system will not be optimal if you use both radios simultaneously.  
Typically, when both radios operate in the 7530 G2 at the same time, they cannot  
transmit simultaneously – this has a negative impact on overall system throughput.  
To minimize the impact on the backbone 802.11 network, Psion Teklogix  
recommends using Bluetooth peripherals that have low transaction rates (such as  
printers and scanners).  
Bluetooth peripherals are configured by choosing the Bluetooth icon in the Control  
Panel. Refer to “Bluetooth Setup” on page 114 for information about setting up  
your Bluetooth devices for communication. In addition, review the manual shipped  
with your Bluetooth device to determine the method used to associate with the 7530  
G2 host.  
6.11 The 7530 G2 Picker Cradle  
The 7530 G2 picker cradle is a highly ruggedized, single station dock. Although  
it provides quick insertion and removal, the cradle holds the 7530 G2 securely even  
when operated in high vibration environments (such as vehicles not equipped with  
suspensions).  
228 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
Picker Cradle Mounting Recommendations  
The7530 G2 base picker cradle can be outfitted with two options – a power module  
and a port replicator. Psion Teklogix also supplies a range of standard mounts for  
the hand-held picker cradles, and the 7530 G2 picker cradle is compatible with all  
of them.  
6.11.1 Picker Cradle Mounting Recommendations  
Warning:  
Before mounting a picker cradle in a vehicle, there are a number  
of operator safety issues that require careful attention. An improp-  
erly mounted cradle may result in one or more of the following:  
operator injury, operator visibility obstruction, operator distraction  
recommends that you seek professional mounting advice from the  
vehicle manufacturer.  
Cable routing within a vehicle cab also requires careful consider-  
ation, especially for separately tethered scanners and other devices  
with loose cables. If you are unable to obtain suitable advice,  
contact Psion Teklogix for assistance (see Appendix A: Support Ser-  
vices And Worldwide Offices). Note also that for better protection,  
the equipment should be mounted inside the vehicle roll cage.  
Pedestal mounts are recommended for all fixed mount locations because they offer  
optimal operator access. In addition, for safety reasons, only pedestal mounts with  
fully locking joints should be used in vehicles. Always adjust the pedestal for the  
optimum viewing angle, and securely tighten the hex and wing screws.  
The most effective way to mount the picker cradle is to use the four #8-32 threaded  
inserts on the rear of the unit. Bolts must not extend more than 10mm (3/8") into  
the cradle.  
To accommodate the service loop of the connector cable, leave a 4" clearance at the  
bottom of the cradle. Leave a 7" (minimum) clearance at the top of the cradle to  
allow easy removal of the hand-held. Also remember to leave at least a 3" clearance  
at the sides of the cradle to allow activation of the release knobs. Refer to the  
detailed assembly instructions that are packaged with the cradle when selecting a  
mounting location.  
6.11.1.1 Mounting Template  
The picker cradle is shipped with detailed mounting instructions including a  
drill template.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 229  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
Wiring Guidelines  
6.11.2 Wiring Guidelines  
Before installing the cables between the cradle and other devices, consider  
the following:  
Ensure that drilling holes will not damage the vehicle or its wiring.  
Protect cable runs from pinching, overheating and physical damage.  
Use grommets to protect cables that pass through metal.  
Use plastic straps and tie-downs to secure cables and connectors in their  
desired location, away from areas where they may get snagged or pulled.  
Keep cables away from heat sources, grease, battery acid and other  
potential hazards.  
Keep cables away from control pedals and other moving parts that may  
damage the cables or interfere with the operation of the vehicle.  
6.11.3 Using The Picker Cradle  
If your 7530 G2 is equipped with a shoulder strap or cover, these accessories need to  
be removed before installing the unit in a picker cradle. There is no need to remove  
handstraps, pistol grips or tethered devices from the unit.  
Slide the 7530 G2 into the cradle, and press firmly downward until it locks  
into place. On a vehicle, it’s a good idea to pull up on the 7530 G2 to be  
certain that it is secure.  
To remove the 7530 G2, press firmly on one of the knobs on either side of  
the cradle until it releases. You do not need to press both knobs.  
6.11.4 Maintaining The Picker Cradle  
Two latches in the cradle hold the 7530 G2 firmly in place. Although these latches  
are designed for at least 80,000 cycles, they will wear over time and will no longer  
lock the 7530 G2 securely in the cradle. For replacement parts and instructions  
contact Psion Teklogix (see Appendix A: Support Services And Worldwide  
Offices). Partial disassembly is required.  
230 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
Powered Cradle Installation In High Voltage Vehicles  
6.11.5 Powered Cradle Installation In High Voltage Vehicles  
Warning:  
Voltages exceeding 60VDC are considered hazardous. For powered  
cradle installations on vehicles with batteries above this voltage,  
ensure the powered cradle power connector is mounted in a dry  
location on the vehicle, or that the connector is insulated with an  
appropriate waterproof material after installation. The connector  
must also be installed out of the vehicle operator’s reach. Exposing  
an accessible power connector to water or other liquids could create  
a hazardous situation resulting in serious injury or death.  
Installation of powered cradles in vehicles that operate above 60VDC require  
special consideration.  
Due to the hazardous voltages present on these vehicles, it is necessary to ensure  
that the powered cradle power supply cable connector is not accessible to the  
vehicle operator, and does not get exposed to water or other liquids. This can be  
accomplished in one of the following ways:  
Ensure the power connector is installed in a dry location on the vehicle,  
away from the vehicle operator’s reach (perhaps under a vehicle dash or in a  
sealed housing).  
Cover the power connector with a waterproof heat shrink material.  
Wrap the connector securely with a waterproof electrical tape in an area out  
of the vehicle operators reach.  
All other installation requirements outlined in this document should also be  
followed for High Voltage vehicles to insure safe installation and operation of the  
powered cradle.  
6.11.6 Powered Cradle Installation  
The powered cradle option is designed to allow the 7530 G2 to be powered by a  
vehicle battery. The battery installed in the 7530 G2 is also recharged by the vehicle  
battery. This option accepts DC power sources over the range 12V to 80V.  
The 7530 G2 picker cradle can be ordered with the powered cradle option installed,  
or it can be retrofitted later at an authorized Psion Teklogix service depot. Service  
offices are listed in Appendix A: Support Services And Worldwide Offices.  
The 7530 G2 charging LED (see “Charge LED” on page 43) indicates that external  
power is available, and it also indicates the charging status of the internal battery.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 231  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
Wiring Vehicle Power To The Cradle  
Warning:  
Warning:  
Applying a voltage above 90VDC or reversing polarity may result  
in permanent damage to the cradle power option and will void the  
product warranty.  
TO AVOID ELECTRIC SHOCK when the powered cradle option  
is installed, always ensure that the rear panel ground lug on the  
picker cradle is connected to the vehicle chassis. Failure to do this  
could result in serious injury or death.  
The metal chassis of the picker cradle must be connected directly to the chassis of  
the vehicle. A safety ground lug (clearly labelled on the rear of the cradle chassis) is  
provided for this purpose. The grounding strap must connect from the ground stud  
on the picker cradle to a solid, reliable contact point on the main portion of the  
vehicle chassis. It must not be connected to battery negative or a terminal block.  
This grounding strap ensures that if there is a fault in the vehicle wiring or in the  
picker cradle power module, the picker cradle cannot be at a hazardous voltage with  
respect to the vehicle chassis.  
Connection between the picker cradle ground lug and the vehicle chassis should be  
done with a 16 gauge ground strap (ground wire). Connect the ground strap to the  
picker cradle utilizing the ground lug hardware supplied with the picker cradle and a  
#10 heavy duty wire crimp ring terminal. Torque the ground lug hardware to 23.0  
+/- 2.0 in-lbs. Connect the other end of the ground strap to a solid, reliable point on  
the main portion of the vehicle chassis, ensuring a solid electrical connection.  
As with other vehicle cables, the routing of the ground strap should be carefully  
considered to ensure it does not pose a hazard to the operator or the safe operation of  
the vehicle. If necessary, secure the ground strap with cable ties or some other  
mechanical means to prevent loops or loose lengths of wire that could catch on  
stationary items when the vehicle is in motion.  
6.11.6.1 Wiring Vehicle Power To The Cradle  
A 1.8 meter (6 foot) extension power cable (PN 13985-302) is supplied with your  
power cradle. This cable should be wired to a filtered, fused (maximum 10A)  
accessory supply on the vehicle. The power cradle draws no more than 8A (less if  
the accessory supply is greater than 12V). Any additional wiring, connectors or  
disconnects used should be rated for at least 10A.  
232 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 6: Peripheral Devices & Accessories  
The Port Replicator  
The red lead of the power cable attaches to the positive vehicle supply. The black  
lead connects to the negative supply – this should be connected to a proper terminal  
block and not to the vehicle body. The power cradle is fully isolated and can be used  
with both negative and positive chassis vehicles.  
You may have the option of connecting power before or after the ‘key’ switch. It is  
preferable to wire the power cradle after the key switch – that is, it cannot be turned  
on without the key on. However, if the operator switches the key off repeatedly for  
long periods during a shift, it may make more sense to wire the cradle before the  
switch.  
Keep in mind that the 7530 G2 will continue to operate with or without vehicle  
power as long as its battery has sufficient charge.  
If an unfused power source must be used, a fuse assembly (PN 19440) must be  
added to the extension power cable (the fuse and instructions are supplied with the  
cable). Use only a 10A slow blow UL approved fuse in the fuse assembly.  
6.11.7 The Port Replicator  
The port replicator is an optional accessory that allows tethered devices (e.g.,  
scanners) as well as mounted peripherals (e.g., bar code printers or weigh scales) to  
be attached to the picker cradle. The replicator can be used with or without the  
cradle power option.  
The functionality of the 7530 G2 tether port is duplicated on the port replicator. In  
addition to the tether port, the replicator is equipped with a standard 9 pin RS232D  
serial interface. This interface is typically used for fixed peripherals such as printers.  
Your serial device likely includes a suitable cable connector for this port.  
Note: The 7530 G2 picker cradle can be ordered with the port replicator option  
installed, or it can be retrofitted later by an authorized Psion Teklogix  
service depot. Service offices are listed in Appendix A: Support Services  
And Worldwide Offices.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 233  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6.12 Tether Adaptor Cables  
The following standard tether cables are available for the external scanners:  
CA1010 JB5 to DE9 RS232 Serial Cable: Straight through wiring.  
CA1015 JB5 to DE9 RS232 Serial Cable: Null modem (signal lines are  
crossed-over).  
CA1020 JB5 to Type B USB: Connects to USB devices with Type B  
receptacles.  
For the pinout diagrams for 7530 G2 USB cables PN CA1020 and PN CA1010,  
refer to Appendix B: “Port Pinouts”, page B-3  
Special intermediate cabling assemblies are available to allow older devices or  
unique peripherals to be connected to the JB5 tether port. These cabling assemblies  
permit scanner cables to be re-terminated in an intermediate in-line connector  
(called LTW), which then interfaces to one of a number of standard adaptor cables  
with JB5 terminations.  
These kits include assembly instructions and include the mating connector.  
1002162 Cable Adaptor LTW - JB5 Scan Decoded.  
1002163 Cable Adaptor LTW - JB5 Scan Undecoded.  
1002164 Cable Adaptor LTW - JB5 Scan RS-232.  
1002165 Cable Adaptor LTW - JB5 Scan RFID.  
1002166 Cable Adaptor LTW - JB5 Scan USB.  
Contact Psion Teklogix support services (see Appendix A: “Support Services And  
Worldwide Offices”) for assistance in the creation of these cable assemblies if you  
wish to take advantage of this capability.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
7.6.4.1 Decode Zones – SE 1524ER. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245  
7.6.5 EV15 Imager Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245  
7.6.5.1 Decode Zone– EV15. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .246  
7.6.6 SX5303 Imager Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247  
7.6.6.1 Decode Zone – SX5303 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247  
7.7 1900 mAh Lithium-Ion Battery Pack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247  
7.8 2400 mAh Lithium-Ion Battery Pack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 235  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 7: Specifications  
7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer Specifications  
Note: Performance specifications are nominal and subject to change  
without notice.  
7.1 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer Specifications  
Size  
270mmL x 100mmW x 85mmD (10.6"L x 3.9"W x 3.3"D)  
Keypad grip area: 77mmW x 43mmD (3"W x 1.7"D)  
Weight  
950g (30.5oz - Troy)  
Includes std. battery, std radio & std. internal scanner  
Pistol grip add 125g (4oz - Troy)  
Operating System  
Microsoft Windows CE 5.0  
Processor And Memory  
520 MHz XScale PXA 270 processor  
32KB instruction/32KB data cache  
On-board RAM: 128MB SDRAM  
On-board RAM: 64MB FLASH  
Power  
Up to 12 hours usage Lithium Ion standard battery (reduced in  
freezer applications  
Optional high capacity battery – up to 17 hours (reduced in  
freezer applications)  
Quick swap packs  
Advanced Smart Battery with gas gauge  
Built-in fast charger (2 hour typical recharge)  
Adjustable battery allocation between system backup and runtime  
System backup during battery swap (15 minutes)  
1 week real-time clock backup  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 237  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 7: Specifications  
7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer Specifications  
External Ports  
Tether port with:  
-
-
-
one RS232 serial port  
decoded/undecoded scanner, printer  
USB host port, power out  
Docking station port with:  
-
-
-
-
one RS232 serial port including diagnostics  
USB device port  
USB host port  
Power in/out  
Internal Expansion Slots  
One SDIO (MultiMediaCard) slot  
One Type II Comp[act Flash slot  
One Type III Extended PC Card slot  
Environmental  
Operating temp: -30°C to +60°C (-22°F to 140°F)  
Storage temp: -40°C to +60°C (-40°F to 140°F)  
Humidity: 5% - 95% RH non-condensing  
Rain/Dust: IEC 529, classification IP67  
Drop Rating: 6' (2m) multiple drops plus 5' (1.5m) drop to polished con-  
crete, 26 times  
Cradle shock: 30g in each axis  
Cradle vibration: 1.5g RMS PSD (4 - 500 Hz) (random)  
Frost-free scan window option  
Approvals  
-
RoHS compliant (EU Directive 2002/95/EC)  
-
-
-
Safety: UL 1950, CSA C22.2 No950, LVD EN60950  
EMC: FCC Part 15 Class B, EMC Directive Class B  
Laser: IEC 60825-1 2001 Class 2 (EN60825-1),  
*Note this product will carry the CE Mark  
238 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 7: Specifications  
Radio Specifications  
7.2 Radio Specifications  
802.11g Direct Sequence Spread Spectrum And Orthogonal Frequency  
Division Multiplexing (OFDM) (Model Number RA2040)  
Form Factor  
Compact Flash  
Antenna Port  
Transmit Power  
Frequency Range  
Channels  
Single U.FL jack, no diversity  
32mW max (+15dBm), all versions  
2.400 - 2.4835GHz, all versions  
1 to 11 for USA, Canada  
1-13 for EU countries  
RX Sensitivity  
(8% FER, 1024 bytes packet) =  
-89dBm @ 1Mbps, -87dBm @ 11Mbps,  
-83dBm @ 6Mbps, -72dBm @ 54Mbps  
6, 9, 12, 18, 24, 36, 48 & 54Mbps  
Data Rates  
RA1001A - Narrow Band Radio  
Psion Teklogix Proprietary Narrowband Modulation (2/4 level FSK)  
Type III PC Card Form Factor  
Transmit Power  
1W or 0.5W  
Frequency Range  
403-422MHz, 419-435MHz, 435-451MHz,  
450-470MHz, 464-480MHz,  
480-496MHz, 496-512MHz  
< -110dBm @ 19.2kbps (4 level FSK)  
4800bps, 9600bps, 19.2kbps  
Rx Sensitivity  
Data Rates  
Bluetooth Radio  
Embedded (USB interface)  
Bluetooth Version  
1.2 compliant (features Adaptive Frequency  
Hopping for better co-existence with 802.11 radio)  
2dBi peak  
-3dBm (0.5mW) minimum, +4dBm (2.5mW) max  
2.400 - 2.4835GHz  
Chip Antenna  
Transmit Power  
Frequency Range  
RX Sensitivity  
(BER<=0.1%)  
Data Rate  
-80dBm max  
732.2kbps and 57.6kbps asymmetric,  
433.9kbps symmetric  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 239  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Chapter 7: Specifications  
Internal Scanner Port  
7.3 Internal Scanner Port  
Compatibility  
1D Imager:  
2D Imager:  
1D Lasers:  
EV15  
SX5303  
SE 1200HP 1D non-decoded, standard range  
SE 1200LR 1D non-decoded, long range  
SE 1200ALR 1D non-decoded, advanced  
long range  
SE1224 1D decoded with fuzzy logic processing  
SE 1524ER decoded with fuzzy logic processing,  
extended range  
2D Laser:  
SE 2223 PDF decoded raster  
7.4 RFID Applications  
-
RD7950 Integrated UHF RFID Reader (future release)  
-
-
Psion Teklogix RFID File System  
Multi-protocol support  
7.5 External Scanners  
Supported Types  
Interface  
Decoded and Non-Decoded 5V only.  
Via tether port.  
This section lists specifications for the following internal scanners:  
SE 1200 High Performance and Long Range (page 241).  
SE 1200 Advanced Long Range and SE 2223PDF (page 241).  
SE 1224 High Performance (page 243).  
SE 1524 Extended Range (page 244).  
EV15 (page 245).  
SX5303 2D Imager Scanner (page 247).  
240 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Chapter 7: Specifications  
SE 1200 High Performance & Long Range Specs  
7.6.1 SE 1200 High Performance & Long Range Specs  
Parameter  
Light Source  
SE 1200HP  
Visible Laser Diode 650 nm.  
SE 1200LR  
Visible Laser Diode 650 nm.  
Scan Rate  
35 (± 5) scans/sec (bidirectional) 35 (± 5) scans/sec (bidirectional)  
Scan Angle  
Scan Patterns  
42º± 2º  
Linear  
23º± 2º  
Linear  
Minimum 20% absolute  
dark/light reflectance measured dark/light reflectance measured  
at 650 nm.  
Minimum 40% absolute  
Minimum Print Con-  
trast  
at 650 nm.  
UPC/EAN, Code 128, Code  
UPC/EAN, Code 128, Code  
39, Code 93, I 2 of 5, Discrete 2 39, Code 93, I 2 of 5,  
of 5, Codabar, MSI UCC/EAN Discrete 2 of 5, Codabar, MSI,  
Symbologies  
128.  
UCC/EAN 128.  
Laser On Time, Aim Duration, Laser On Time, Aim Duration,  
Programmable  
Parameters  
Symbology types/lengths,  
Data formatting.  
Symbology types/lengths,  
Data formatting.  
Artificial: 450 ft. candles  
(4844 Lux).  
Sunlight: 10000 ft. candles  
(107,640 Lux).  
Artificial: 450 ft. candles  
(4844 Lux).  
Sunlight: 8000 ft. candles  
(86,112 Lux).  
Ambient Light:  
7.6.2 SE 1200 Advanced Long Range & SE 2223PDF Specs  
Parameter  
Light Source  
SE 1200ALR  
Visible Laser Diode 650 nm.  
SE 2223 PDF  
Visible Laser Diode 650 nm.  
Scan Rate  
35 (± 5) scans/sec (bi-directional) 590 scan/sec. 22 frames/sec.  
Scan Angle  
Scan Patterns  
13º± 2º  
Linear  
Horizontal: 34º, Vertical: 12.5º  
Linear and Smart Raster  
Minimum 40% absolute  
dark/light reflectance measured  
at 650 nm.  
Minimum 40% absolute  
dark/light reflectance measured at 35% absolute dark/light reflec-  
650 nm.  
Minimum Print  
Contrast  
tance differential (PDF).  
25% absolute dark/light reflec-  
tance differential (1-D).  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 241  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 7: Specifications  
Decode Zones – SE 1200HP, LR AND ALR  
Parameter  
SE 1200ALR  
SE 2223 PDF  
PDF417, Micro PDF,  
UPC/EAN, Code 128, UCC/EAN UPC/EAN, Code 39, Inter-  
128, RSS, Code 39, Code 93, I 2 of leaved 2 of 5, Code 128, Coda-  
5, Discrete 2 of 5, Codabar, MSI. bar, MSI Plessey, RSS and  
Composite codes.  
Symbologies  
Laser On Time, Aim Duration,  
Laser On Time, Aim Duration,  
Symbology types/lengths, Data  
formatting.  
Power Mode, Trigger Mode,  
Bidirectional Redundancy,  
Symbology types/lengths, Data  
formatting, Pattern Controls.  
Artificial: 450 ft. candles  
(4844 Lux).  
Programmable  
Parameters  
Artificial: 450 ft. candles  
(4844 Lux).  
Sunlight: 4000 ft. candles  
(43,056 Lux).  
Ambient Light:  
Sunlight: 8000 ft. candles  
(86112 Lux).  
7.6.2.1 Decode Zones – SE 1200HP, LR AND ALR  
Bar Code  
Read Distance  
High  
Performance  
Advanced  
Long Range  
Long Range  
Min Max  
Min  
Max  
Min Max  
5 mil 3.0" 4.5"  
7.5 mil 3.0" 8.5"  
10 mil 2.5" 12.5" 13.0" 17.5"  
15 mil 2.5" 18.5" 8.5" 33.5" 20.0" 50.0"  
20 mil 2.5" 20.5" 9.5" 38.5" 30.0" 60.0"  
40 mil 3.0" 29.5" 9.5" 79.5" 30.0" 98.0"  
115.0  
55 mil 3.5" 35.5" 9.5" 89.5" 27.0"  
"
242 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 7: Specifications  
Decode Zones – SE 2223PDF  
7.6.2.2 Decode Zones – SE 2223PDF  
Raster Laser Scanner  
Bar Code  
Read Distance  
PDF Bar Codes  
SE2223  
Min  
Max  
6.5 mil  
10 mil  
15 mil  
2.5"  
2.5"  
2.5"  
6.5"  
9.5"  
15.5"  
7.6.3 SE 1224HP Scanner Specifications  
Parameter  
Light Source  
SE 1224HP  
Visible Laser Diode 650 nm.  
35 (± 5) scans/sec  
(bi-directional)  
42º (typical), 30º  
(narrow)  
Scan Rate  
Scan Angle  
Scan Patterns  
Linear  
Minimum 25% absolute dark/light reflectance measured at  
650 nm.  
Minimum Print Contrast  
UPC/EAN, Code 128, UCC/EAN 128, RSS, Code 39, Code  
93, I 2 of 5, Discrete 2 of 5, Codabar, MSI.  
Laser On Time, Aim Duration, Power Mode, Trigger Mode,  
Bi-directional Redundancy, Symbology types/lengths,  
Data formatting.  
Symbologies  
Programmable  
Parameters  
Artificial: 450 ft. candles (4844 Lux).  
Sunlight: 8000 ft. candles (86112 Lux).  
Ambient Light:  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 243  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 7: Specifications  
Decode Zone – SE 1224HP  
7.6.3.1 Decode Zone – SE 1224HP  
7.6.4 SE 1524ER – Extended Range Scanner Specifications  
Parameter  
Light Source  
SE 1524ER  
Visible Laser Diode 650 nm.  
Scan Rate  
35 (±5) scans/sec (bi-directional).  
Scan Angle  
Scan Patterns  
13.5° ±0.7°  
Linear  
Minimum Print Contrast Minimum 25% absolute dark/light reflectance measured at 650 nm.  
UPC/EAN, Code 128, UCC.EAN128, RSS, Code 39, Code 93,I  
2 of 5, Discrete 2 of 5, Codabar, MSI.  
Symbologies  
Laser On Time, Aim Duration, Power Mode, Trigger Mode,  
Bi-directional Redundancy, Symbology types/lengths,  
Data formatting.  
Programmable  
Parameters  
Artificial: 450 ft. candles (4,844 Lux).  
Sunlight: 4,000 ft. candles (86,112 Lux).  
Ambient Light:  
244 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 7: Specifications  
Decode Zones – SE 1524ER  
7.6.4.1 Decode Zones – SE 1524ER  
Figure 7.1 1524ER Decode Zone A (short-range, small codes)  
Figure 7.2 1524ER Decode Zone B (long-range, large codes)  
7.6.5 EV15 Imager Specifications  
Parameter  
EV15  
617nm Highly Visible LED  
40º  
Light Source  
Scan Angle  
Minimum Print Contrast  
Min x. Dimension  
Minimum 25%  
0.1 mm (4 mils)  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 245  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Chapter 7: Specifications  
Decode Zone– EV15  
Parameter  
Reading Distance  
EV15  
Up to 90cm (35 in)  
UPC (E&A), EAN, RSS, Code 39, Code 128,  
UCC/EAN 128, ISBN, ISBT, Interleaved,  
Matrix, Industrial and Standard 2 of 5, Codabar,  
Code 93/93i, Code 11, MSI, Plessey, Telepen,  
PDF417, Micro PDF417  
Symbologies  
Works in any lighting conditions, from 0 to  
100,000 lux  
Ambient Light  
Shock  
Vibration  
2000G, 0.7ms, half sinus, 3 axes  
50G r.m.s.  
7.6.5.1 Decode Zone– EV15  
246 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 7: Specifications  
SX5303 Imager Specifications  
7.6.6 SX5303 Imager Specifications  
Parameter  
SX5303  
1.3 megapixel (1280 x 1024)  
Optics  
Field of View at 6 inches 10.3 in. x 8.2 in.  
Pitch Angle  
±45°  
Skew Angle  
Ambient Light  
Minimum Contrast  
Targeting  
±45°  
200 Lux to full sunlight.  
10%  
Center locating 623 nm LED.  
Linear: Code 39; UPC/EAN; I2of5; Code 128; Codabar; RSS  
PDF417: PDF417, microPDF417; Composite; image capture  
and signature capture.  
Data Matrix: Data Matrix; QR Code; Maxicode; Aztec Code;  
Planet; Postnet; Royal Mail 4SCC; 4 State postal codes from  
Australia, Canada, Japan; Korean Post 3of5.  
Decode Symbologies  
Supported  
7.6.6.1 Decode Zone – SX5303  
Min. Range Max. Range  
(inches) (inches)  
Code  
Mil Size  
Data Matrix  
Data Matrix  
Data Matrix  
PDF417  
PDF417  
QR  
Code 39  
Code 39  
Code 39  
Code 128  
10 mil  
12.5 mil  
15.8 mil  
10 mil  
15 mil  
15 mil  
5 mil  
10 mil  
15.8 mil  
10 mil  
3.25 in.  
5.0 in.  
2.75 in.  
2.5 in.  
5.5 in.  
5.75 in.  
6.0 in.  
7.25 in.  
5.75 in.  
5.0 in.  
6.5 in.  
7.0 in.  
6.5 in.  
2.5 in.  
2.75 in.  
2.25 in.  
3.25 in.  
2.25 in.  
2.25 in.  
2.25 in.  
Typical performance @ 300 lux  
7.7 1900 mAh Lithium-Ion Battery Pack  
Technology  
Capacity  
Lithium-Ion (Li-Ion)  
1900mAh nominal at 300mA discharge 20°C to  
8.25V  
1400mAh nominal at 300mA discharge at -20°C to  
8.25V  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual 247  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 7: Specifications  
2400 mAh Lithium-Ion Battery Pack  
Charge Temperature  
Discharge Temperature  
Storage Temperature  
5°C to 39°C (41°F to 102°F)  
-30°C to 60°C (-22°F to 140°C)  
-30°C to 60°C (-22°F to 140°C)  
Storage at elevated temperatures not recommended  
Charge Cycles  
Minimum 300 cycles with no degradation below  
70% of nominal capacity  
Voltage  
11.1V nominal (8.25V mn. to 12.6V max.)  
Cell Configuration  
Cell Type  
1P3S (3 series connected cells)  
Prismatic  
Max. Charge Voltage  
Charge Time  
12.6V +/- 0.09V  
1.5 hr  
7.8 2400 mAh Lithium-Ion Battery Pack  
Technology  
Capacity  
Lithium-Ion (Li-Ion)  
2400mAh nominal at 300mA discharge 20°C to  
8.25V  
2000mAh nominal at 300mA discharge at -20°C to  
8.25V  
Charge Temperature  
Discharge Temperature  
Storage Temperature  
5°C to 39°C (41°F to 102°F)  
-30°C to 60°C (-22°F to 140°C)  
-30° C to 60° C (-22° F to 140° C)  
Storage at elevated temperatures not recommended  
Charge Cycles  
Minimum 300 cycles with no degradation below  
70% of nominal capacity  
Voltage  
11.1V nominal (8.25V mn. to 12.6V max.)  
1P3S (3 series connected cells)  
Cylindrical  
Cell Configuration  
Cell Type  
Max. Charge Voltage  
Fast Charge Time  
12.6V +/- 0.09V  
2.5 hr  
248 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
APPENDIX  
SUPPORT SERVICES AND WORLDWIDE OFFICES  
A
Psion Teklogix provides a complete range of product support services to its  
customers worldwide. These services include technical support and product repairs.  
A.1 Technical Support  
For technical support in North America:  
Call Toll free: +1 800 387 8898 Option 3 or  
Direct Dial:  
+1 905 813 9900 Ext. 1999 Option 3  
For technical support in EMEA (Europe, Middle East and Africa), please contact  
the local office listed in the website below:  
http://www.psionteklogix.com/EMEASupport  
For technical support in Asia, contact the local office listed in the website below:  
http://www.psionteklogix.com  
Technical Support for Mobile Computing Products is provided via email through  
the Psion Teklogix customer and partner extranets. To reach the website, go to  
www.psionteklogix.com, and click on the appropriate Teknet link on the home page.  
Then click on the “Login” button or the “Register” button, depending on whether  
you have previously registered for Teknet. Once you have logged in, search for the  
“Support Request Form”.  
A.2 Product Repairs  
For repair service in North America:  
Call Toll free: +1 800 387 8898 Option 2 or  
Direct Dial:  
+1 905 813 9900 Ext. 1999 Option 2  
For repair service in EMEA (Europe, Middle East and Africa), please contact the  
local office listed in the website below:  
http://www.psionteklogix.com/EMEASupport  
For repair service in Asia, contact the local office listed in the website below:  
http://www.psionteklogix.com  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual A-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Appendix A: Support Services And Worldwide Offices  
Worldwide Offices  
A.3 Worldwide Offices  
COMPANY HEADQUARTERS  
Psion Teklogix Inc.  
2100 Meadowvale Boulevard  
Mississauga  
Ontario  
Canada L5N 7J9  
Tel:  
+1 905 813 9900  
Fax: +1 905 812 6300  
CANADIAN SERVICE CENTRE  
Psion Teklogix Inc.  
7170 West Credit Ave., Unit #1  
Mississauga, Ontario  
Canada L5N 7J9  
Tel:  
+1 800 387 8898  
Option 2 - or -  
Direct: + 1 905 813 9900  
Fax: + 1 905 812 6304  
Web: www.psionteklogix.com  
Ext. 1999 Option 2  
NORTH AMERICAN HEADQUARTERS AND U.S. SERVICE CENTRE  
Psion Teklogix Corp.  
1810 Airport Exchange Boulevard  
Suite 500  
Erlanger, Kentucky  
USA 41018  
Tel:  
+1 859 371 6006  
Fax: +1 859 371 6422  
INTERNATIONAL SUBSIDIARIES (see also www.psionteklogix.com)  
Psion Teklogix S.A.  
La Duranne  
135 Rue Rene Descartes  
BP 421000  
13591 Aix-En-Provence  
Cedex 3; France  
Tel:  
+33 4 42 90 88 09  
Fax: +33 4 42 90 88 88  
A-2 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
APPENDIX  
B
PORT PINOUTS  
B.1 Tether Port Pinout  
The tether port connector incorporates multiplexed undecoded scanner, decoded  
scanner, RS232 serial, and USB interfaces. In order for it to operate, a special wiring  
scheme is needed. If you have a need to create cables for the tether port, contact a  
Psion Teklogix representative and request document #1010032 “Instruction Tether  
Port Termination”. Attempting to interface to the tether connector without  
following this document may cause damage to the 7530 G2 or the tethered device.  
B.2 Docking Station Connector  
2 4 6 8 10 12  
1 3 5 7 9 11  
1. Ext 5V Switched. Used by external peripherals. 5VDC, 1A max.  
2. RS232 Rx Data. Console receive pin.  
3. RS232 Tx Data. Console transmit pin  
4. DC Power In (13-18VDC @ 3A max). External power adapter  
positive input.  
5. USB Host Minus. For connecting USB devices.  
6. USB Host Plus. For connecting USB devices.  
7. DC Power In. Same as pin 4.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual B-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Appendix B: Port Pinouts  
Battery Contacts  
8. Docking Station Id. Identifies device attached to the docking station  
connector. The external device applies a specific resistance between  
this pin and ground as identification.  
9. Ground.  
10. USB Device Minus. Connects to other USB host such as a PC.  
11. USB Device Plus. Connects to other USB host such as a PC.  
12. Ground  
B.3 Battery Contacts  
These contacts represent right to left numbering with the docking port pointing  
toward you, and the battery contacts facing upward.  
Battery Contacts  
Pin #  
Signal  
POS  
Description  
1
2
3
4
5
Positive Battery  
SMBUS Clock  
Presence/Cell Count  
SMBUS Data  
CLK  
BAT_D  
DATA  
NEG  
Negative Battery  
B-2 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Appendix B: Port Pinouts  
JB5 To USB Type B Cable - PN CA1020  
B.4 JB5 To USB Type B Cable - PN CA1020  
(Mates with USB devices that incorporate Type B receptacles)  
B.5 JB5 To RS-232 Serial Cable - PN CA1010  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual B-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
APPENDIX  
C
USB SETUP APPLICATION  
C.1 USB Setup  
The USB Setup application is used to update a Windows PC so that it can connect to  
a Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 using the USB port on the Portable Docking Module  
(PDM) connector. To download the USB Setup application, go to:  
www.psionteklogix.com/downloads  
This will take you to the Teknet home page.  
Login with your Teknet Username and Password. (If you’re not already a  
member of Teknet, you can register for free at this home page so that you  
can access the USB Setup application.)  
Once you’ve entered your name and password, the Download page is displayed.  
Scroll down to the Utilities heading, and then under USB Setup, tap on  
Download. If you need further assistance, please contact Psion Teklogix  
support (1-800-387-8898).  
System Requirements  
Windows 2000 or XP  
ActiveSync 3.5 or later  
The install program:  
updates copies of the device installation scripts usbstor.infand  
wceusbsh.infwith Psion Teklogix-specific information, and  
sets up a USB connection between the PC and the 7530 G2.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual C-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Appendix C: USB Setup Application  
Launching The Application  
C.1.1 Launching The Application  
Before running the USB Setup application:  
1. Unplug the 7530 G2 from your PC, and exit all running applications.  
2. Double-click on the USB Setup executable in the directory you copied  
it to.  
Welcome Dialog Box  
If you check the “Install as a generic device” checkbox, the Hardware  
Manager on your PC will not prompt you to install every new device you  
connect to your PC. A generic configuration will be used for the Psion Tek-  
logix devices.  
3. Tap on the Install button to configure your PC or the Cancel button to  
exit the USB Setup program.  
The program checks that ActiveSync is installed and that it is a supported  
version – 3.5 or later. If the version installed on your PC is not supported,  
you’ll need to exit the USB Setup application, and install a later version of  
ActiveSync. ActiveSync can be downloaded from Microsoft at:  
http://www.microsoft.com/downloads.  
C-2 Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Appendix C: USB Setup Application  
Installation Complete Dialog Box  
In some cases, you may see an additional dialog:  
Usually, this dialog is shown when more than one version of ActiveSync is  
installed. You can either select the correct inf file for the USB Setup  
program to work with, or you can cancel the installation, and uninstall the  
extra copies of ActiveSync.  
C.1.2 Installation Complete Dialog Box  
This dialog box indicates the success or failure of the installation.  
4. Tap on Exit to exit the application.  
If you need to view the log file, tap on View Log.  
Once the USB Setup program is exited, you can connect the 7530 G2 to  
your PC using a PDM connector and a USB cable, and turn the unit on. If  
the USB Setup process was successful, the “Found new hardware” wizard  
may start. If this occurs, choose the recommended defaults. ActiveSync will  
detect your 7530 G2.  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual C-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Auto Radio Address (Cellular Radio) 139  
Auto Radio Address (Cellular Radio  
A
Accepted Start Char 175  
accessories  
bar code readers, connecting 215  
handstrap 15  
picker cradle 228  
pistol grip 16  
Active Conn Tab 119  
ActiveSync  
display 88  
intensity 41  
backup profile, creating (Total Recall) 126  
backup profile, restoring (Total Recall)  
130  
Bad Scan Beep 197  
ASync profile 116  
Adaptive Windowing 191  
adaptor cables, tether 234  
Addendum 150, 152, 153, 179, 192  
Addendum Add-on 2 179  
Addendum Add-on 5 179  
Addendum Security 180  
Ad Hoc network 20  
Advanced (wireless connection) 25  
Advanced button (Radio tab) 143  
AIAG  
appending to 148, 151, 196  
parameters 144–195  
prefix character 148, 151  
stripping characters 148, 149, 151  
symbologies  
AIAG Strip 147  
AIAG Strip 147  
ALT Key 35  
ANSI  
transmitting data 148, 151  
appearance (display colour scheme) 90  
appending to bar codes  
characters 148, 151, 196  
approvals  
7530 (including scanner) 238  
arrow keys  
moving the cursor 35  
ASCII  
Codabar 153, 167, 180, 192  
Code 11 154, 181  
Code 39 147, 191  
Code 93 153, 167, 181, 192  
Discrete 2 of 5 155, 170, 184  
EAN 13 150, 164, 177  
EAN 8 151, 164, 178  
IATA 2 of 5 156  
Interleaved 2 of 5 154, 168, 182,  
192  
Matrix 2 of 5 183  
MSI Plessey 155, 169, 183  
UPC A 152, 164, 178  
UPC E 152, 165, 178  
trailing characters 151  
bar code reader  
external (specs) 240  
external scanner, operation of 215  
Barcodes Must Decode 188  
batteries  
Full Ascii 147, 174  
audio indicators  
adjusting volume 48  
description of beep conditions 47  
volume adjustment using the BLUE  
key 48  
Authentication, Bluetooth Controls 117  
authentication, network (Shared Mode) 21  
Auto Exposure (Imager) 189  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
I
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
advanced power properties 105  
calibrate power 105  
capacity dialog box 102  
charge, time required 215  
chargers 32  
charging 13  
cycles 215  
devices (card slot power) 106  
gauge 46  
installing 32  
installing in 7530 G2 14  
removing 32  
Cellular Radio Address 139  
Center Bar Code Only (Imager) 187  
CH, Bluetooth Controls 117  
changing password (Start Menu security)  
Channel Enable List 136  
Channel List, editing 138  
Channel Number 135  
Channel Selection 137  
Channel Switch Speed 136  
Channel Tab (Narrow Band radio) 135  
appending to bar codes 148, 151  
run time, maximizing 53  
safety precautions XII  
specifications, 7530 1900mAh 247  
specifications, 7530 2400mAh 248  
suspend threshold 104  
battery charger  
prefix 148, 151  
stripping 148, 149, 151  
suffix 151  
trailing 151  
descriptions of 33  
safety instructions XIV–XV  
battery pack 215  
charging (battery) 13  
battery safety XII–XV  
battery See also batteries 215  
Baud 200, 201, 202, 203  
Baud Rate/Modulation 142  
beeper  
Check Digit 154  
check digit 150, 153, 154, 155, 169  
Check Digit, One 155, 169  
Check Digit Algorithm 170  
Check Digits (MSI Plessey) 169  
Check Digit Verification 162, 175, 177,  
182, 183, 184  
adjusting volume 48  
description of beep conditions 47  
volume adjustment using the BLUE  
key 48  
Bi-Direction Redundancy 159  
BKSP (DEL Key) 35  
Bluetooth, enabling 106  
Bluetooth radio  
changing device name 120  
device service profiles 116  
ISM band 114  
CLSI Editing 167  
CLSI Library System 180  
Codabar 153, 167, 180, 192  
Codabar 167  
Code 11 154, 181  
Code 128 149, 191  
PINs for devices 117  
radio configuration 114–126  
Bluetooth setup 114  
GPRS setup 121  
peripherals 228  
Bright For (backlight) 89  
BSP, Bluetooth Controls 120  
Code 128 163, 175  
Code 128 Emulation 171, 185  
Code 32, Convert To 161  
Code 32 Prefix 161  
Code 39 147  
Code 39 161, 174  
Code 93 153, 167, 181, 192  
Code 93 167  
cold reset 27  
C
cable diagrams C-1  
cables, tether adaptor 234  
calibrating (touchscreen) 41, 108  
Captures Per HW Trigger 189  
card slot power 106  
Cold Reset (Shutdown menu) 73  
II  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
COM, Bluetooth Controls 120  
Command Prompt 68  
Communities 206  
Composite 172, 195  
connection list table, Bluetooth Controls  
119  
Delete Char Set ECIs 160  
Imager 68  
Scanner 68  
Signature 68  
Device Name, changing 120  
dialog box, using 73  
Diff Read Timeout 174  
digit  
Console Port settings 201  
Baud 201, 202, 203  
Data Bits 202, 203  
check digit 150, 153, 154, 155, 169  
Dim For (backlight) 89  
Discrete 2 of 5 155, 170, 184  
Parity 202, 203  
Stop Bits 202, 203  
Constant Illumination 191  
Contact 205  
Continuous Scan Mode 157, 173, 187  
contrast, adjusting 41  
contrast, adjusting display 41  
control panel  
backlight 88  
contrast (control panel) 87  
contrast, adjusting 41  
Display Properties 87  
display contrast, adjusting 41  
Display Properties 87  
docking device icons 47  
docking station  
accessing 82  
basic setup 87  
Display Properties 87  
icons 83  
keyboard properties 90  
power management properties 102  
stylus properties 107  
Conv. UPC-E To UPC-A 165  
Conv. UPC-E1 To UPC-A 165  
Convert To Code 32 161  
Convert To EAN 13 169, 178  
Convert To UPC -A 179  
Convert to UPC-A 152  
cradle See also Picker cradle 228  
CTRL Key 35  
uploading data using 55  
Dot Time 146, 157, 188  
double-click  
appending characters to a decoded  
bar code 196  
Double-Tap (stylus settings) 107  
DUN service, Bluetooth 116  
Duration 157  
cycle tasks 70  
D
data  
EAN 128 175  
entering  
with a bar code reader 215  
Data Bits 200, 202, 203  
Data Squelch 142  
EAN 128 Identifier 176  
EAN 13 150, 164, 177  
EAN 13, Convert To 169  
EAN 8 151, 164, 178  
EAN-8 Zero Extend 164  
EAP (Extensible Authentication Protocol)  
22  
decoded (internal) scanner parameters 156  
decoded Intermec (ISCP) parameters 173  
Decode Performance 162, 163  
Decode Performance Level 162, 163  
Decoder Timeout 190  
decode zones 242, 244, 245, 246  
Default All Parameters 135  
Default Dev. On Reboot 189  
DEL (BKSP) Key 35  
ECI Decoder 160  
Enable Bookland (UPC-EAN) 166  
Enable Bookland EAN 150  
Enable CC-AB 172  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
III  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Enable CC-C 172  
Enable Cellular Protocol 138  
Enable Plessy 183  
Enable Power Saving 141  
Enable RSS Expanded 172, 186  
Enable RSS Limited 172, 186  
Enable RSS-14 171, 186  
Enable SNMP 206  
Include Check (Discrete 2 of 5  
symbology) 155  
Include Check (Interleaved 2 of 5  
symbology) 154  
Include Chk 147, 152, 154  
Include Country 150  
Include Number Sys 152, 153  
Include Sym (Code 128) 149  
indicators  
Enable TLC-39 172  
Encryption, Bluetooth Controls 117  
Error Accept 147  
ESC Key 35  
battery gauge 46  
docking devices 47  
LED functions 43  
modifier keys 45  
narrow band radio signal quality 46  
scanner message 51, 52  
security level 47  
task bar 62  
tethered device 47  
EV15 Intermec 245  
EV15 1D imager scanner specs 245  
Extensible Authentication Protocol (EAP)  
22  
F
Fast Converge (Imager) 190  
features  
802.11radio signal quality 46  
Infrastructure network 20  
bar code reader 215  
Input (translate) 198  
7530 7  
fields  
Field Size 148  
size 148  
FNC1 Conversion 176  
Frequency Table (Radio tab) 143  
Full ASCII 162  
Full Ascii 147, 174  
Function Keys 36  
37-key keyboard 36  
63-key keyboard 36  
Input Panel (control panel) 84  
handstrap 15  
pistol grip 16  
Intensity (7035 backlighting) 89, 92  
Interleaved 2 of 5 154, 168, 182, 192  
Intermec EV15 specs 245  
Internal PDF scanner, operating 51  
Internal scanner (1D), operating 50  
IP address, assigning 23  
ISBN Conversion 177  
ISBT Concat Any Pair 176  
ISBT Concat Transmit 176  
ISBT 128 163, 176  
G
Good Scan Beep 197  
GPRS (bluetooth) 121  
GTIN Compliant 176, 180  
H
handstrap, installing 15  
ISM band, Bluetooth radio 114  
ITF Check (Discrete 2 of 5 symbology)  
155  
ITF Check (IATA 2 of 5 symbology) 156  
ITF Check (I 2 of 5 symbology) 154  
I
IATA 2 of 5 156  
Idle Poll Limit 141  
IEEE radio, configuring 17  
imager  
EV15 imager scanner specs 245  
SX5303 2D imager specs 247  
imager (2D), operating 51  
Imager parameters 187  
Include Check 150, 151, 153, 155, 156  
K
keyboard  
key repeat 90, 92  
one shot mode 93  
IV  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
36-key keyboard 38  
63-key 38  
accessing 37  
executing a macro 95  
keyboard backlight 40  
keyboard keys 33  
ALT 35  
Macros menu, accessing 94  
recording and saving 94  
arrow keys 35  
maintenance 56  
BKSP 35  
Manage Triggers 109  
Manual Radio Address (Cellular Radio  
Address) 139  
Manual Switch Table 137  
Matrix 2 of 5 183  
Max Illumination (Imager) 190  
Max Integration (Imager) 190  
Max Number Barcodes 188  
scanner warning message 197  
Minimum Cancel Time 157, 173  
Minimum Length 175, 177, 181, 182,  
183, 184, 187  
Min Scan Duration 189  
CTRL 35  
DEL 35  
ESC 35  
function keys, accessing 36  
macro keys 37, 94  
modifiers 34  
navigating using the keyboard 59  
one shot mode 93  
SCAN 35  
SHIFT 34  
SPACE 35  
TAB 35  
Keyboard Properties 90, 92  
backlight 92  
one shot mode 93  
Key Index, assigning 22  
Key Repeat tab 91  
keys  
locking 34  
One Shot Mode 93  
unlocking 34  
Modulation/Baud Rate 142  
Mod 10 Check (Discrete 2 of 5  
symbology) 155  
Mod 43 Check 148  
L
LANAccessUsingPPP service, Bluetooth  
116  
Laser On Time 157, 173  
Late TX Limit (Polling) 140  
LED  
MSI Plessey 155, 169, 183  
charge 43  
functions 43  
receive 44  
Name 207  
scan 44  
transmit 44  
name servers, assigning 24  
Channel tab 135  
Info tab 132  
Linear Decode 166  
Linear Security Level 158  
Lithium-Ion batteries  
installing 32  
Low Level screen 134  
Power tab 141  
Protocol tab 138  
Radio tab 142  
removing 32  
Location 205  
Low Level screen (Narrow Nand radio)  
134  
statistics screen 132  
narrow band radio  
signal quality 46  
network  
Low Power Timeout 158  
Ad Hoc 20  
connection, monitoring 55  
M
Macro keys  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
V
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
infrastructure 20  
threshold, power shutdown 104  
Power Off Time 141  
Power Scheme 103  
Power Tab (Narrow Band radio) 141  
Power Up Channel 135  
preferred networks 25  
network authentication (Shared Mode) 21  
Network Key, assigning 21  
non-decoded scanners parameters 145  
NOTIS Editing 167  
O
Prefix Char 148, 151  
Printer (serial service), Bluetooth 116  
profile, restoring backup 130  
One Check Digit 155, 169  
One Shot Mode 93  
ON Threshold 89, 92  
Output (translate) 198  
Command Prompt 68  
P
Internet Explorer 68  
Remote Desktop Connection 68  
Windows Explorer 68  
Protocol Tab (Narrow Band radio) 138  
punctuation marks, accessing (SHIFT  
Key) 34  
Parameter Scanning 158, 174, 175, 176,  
177, 180, 181, 182, 183, 184, 187  
Parity 201, 202, 203  
PDF internal scanner, operating 51  
picker cradle 228  
installing cable 230  
powered 10-55 VDC 228  
powered 12 VDC 228  
unpowered 228  
adding new network connection 19  
advanced settings of 25  
Bluetooth 114–126  
Configure button 19  
configuring 17  
picker cradle See also Picker Cradle 228  
PIN, Bluetooth Controls 116  
pinouts C-1  
PINs, Bluetooth devices 117  
pistol grip, installing 16  
Plessy Transmit Check Digit 184  
pocket PC compatibility 81  
Polling 139  
polling values, testing 140  
Poll Timeout (Polling) 140  
port pinouts C-1  
Port Prefix, Bluetooth Controls 120  
Port Replicator Port A 203  
Port Replicator Tether 202  
ports  
adding a new network connection  
19  
Ad Hoc 20  
authentication, network 21  
Configure button 19  
Connect button 19  
EAP (Extensible Authentication  
Protocol) 22  
Infrastructure 20  
Key Index 22  
Key Index, assigning 22  
Network Key 21  
internal scanner 240  
ports, scanner 199  
Postal  
Network Key, assigning 21  
wireless information 19  
wireless properties 20  
802.1X authentication 22  
Connect button 19  
IP address, assigning 23  
name servers 24  
Narrow Band 132  
preferred networks, arranging 25  
specifications 239  
PlaNET 193  
PostNET 194  
Royal 194  
Power Management Properties 102  
advanced power 105  
battery capacity 102  
calibrate power 105  
devices (card slot power) 106  
scheme, power saving 103  
VI  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
wireless connection, setting up 17  
802.11g Direct Sequence SS 239  
802.11signal quality 46  
radio specifications 239  
Radio Tab (Narrow Band radio) 142  
Raster Expand Rate (2D) 159  
Raster Height (2D) 159  
Reading Range 174, 177, 180, 182  
recalibrating (touchscreen) 41, 108  
receive LED 44  
Remote Desktop Connection 68  
remote desktop connection 81  
Repeat Delay (between key repeats) 91  
Repeat Rate (of key repeats) 91  
Repeat tab (key repeat settings) 91  
resetting the 7530 G2 27  
cold reset 27  
Scanning Mode (2D) 159  
Scan Result 197  
Scan Result Time 197  
stylus, using to navigate 59  
touch pen, using 59  
Security (scan) 147  
Security Level 166  
security level icon 47  
Security Settings 66  
changing password 67  
level 66  
Supervisor 66  
Teklogix 66  
User 66  
Servers, Bluetooth Controls 118  
Services, Bluetooth Controls 116  
Set Length L1 161  
Set Length L2 161  
Set PIN, Bluetooth Controls 117  
warm reset 27  
RFID  
applications 240  
Rights 207  
RSS Code 171, 193  
Run (Start Menu) 72  
Control Panel 71  
S
Taskbar and Start Menu 71  
SE 1200 Advanced LR specs 241  
SE 1200 HP specs 241  
SE 1200 LR specs 241  
SE 1524 ER specs 244  
SE 2223 PDF specs 241  
SHIFT Key 34  
Short Code 146  
safety instructions  
battery charger XIV–XV  
Same Read Timeout 174  
Same Read Validate 174  
Scan Indicator 197  
SCAN Key 35  
Scan Log File 197  
scanning  
appending characters 148, 151, 196  
check digit 155, 169  
decoded (internal) parameters 156  
decoded Intermec (ISCP) parameters  
173  
decode zones 242, 244, 245, 246  
Imager parameters 187  
non-decoded parameters 145  
PDF internal scanner, operating 51  
ports 199  
removing characters 149  
symbologies 144  
techniques 49  
troubleshooting tips 50  
1D internal scanner, operating 50  
2D Internal imager, operating 51  
Cold Reset 73  
Warm Reset 73  
Shutdown (Start Menu) 72  
signal quality, narrow band 46  
signal quality, 802.11 46  
Simple Network Management (SNMP)  
See SNMP 204  
SIP (Soft Input Panel 84  
size  
of fields 148  
Size/Chars (bar code scanning) 148  
Sled See picker cradle. 228  
slot power status, built-in device, enabling  
106  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
VII  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
SNMP (Simple Network Management  
Protocol) 204  
Communities 206  
Contact 205  
taskbar  
onscreen indicators  
Enable SNMP 206  
Location 205  
battery gauge 46  
docking devices 47  
modifier keys 45  
narrow band radio signal quality 46  
security level 47  
tethered device 47  
802.11 radio signal quality 46  
Name 207  
Rights 207  
Soft Input Panel (SIP) 84  
Soft Scan Timeout 197  
SPACE Key 35  
specifications  
using 62  
battery,7530 1900mAh 247  
battery,7530 2400mAh 248  
for 7530 237  
TekImager Enabled 187  
Teklogix security level 66  
TekTerm application 81  
Telepen 186  
Test Squelch (Radio tab) 142  
tether adaptor cables 234  
tethered device  
scanner, internal 240  
Standard (Code 128) 149  
Start/Stop Transmit 174, 180  
Start Menu 65  
cycle tasks 70  
desktop 66  
programs 68  
Run 72  
connecting and disconnecting 52  
taskbar icons 47  
Security 66  
Settings 71  
Tether Port scanner settings 200  
Tether Port settings  
Shutdown 72  
system tray 69  
Baud 200  
task manager 70  
Data Bits 200  
Statistics button (Radio tab) 143  
Statistics screen (Narrow Band radio) 132  
Stop Bits 201, 202, 203  
Strip Leading 148, 151  
Strip Start/Stop Chars 153  
Strip Trailing 149, 151  
stylus (touch pen) 59  
Stylus Properties 107  
Double-tap (stylus sensitivity) 107  
Suffix 160  
Parity 201  
Stop Bits 201  
threshold, setting (backlight) 89, 92  
backup profile, creating 126  
backup profile, restoring 130  
touch pen, using 59  
recalibration 41, 108  
stylus 59  
Suffix Char 148, 151  
Supervisor security level 66  
Supp. Redundancy (Code 128) 166  
Supplementals (UPC-EAN) 166  
Suspend (Shutdown menu) 73  
Suspend State 103  
SX5303 2D imager specs 247  
symbologies  
Transmit Check Digit 175, 177, 178,  
179, 181, 182, 184  
Transmit Check Digit (I 2 of 5) 168  
Transmit Check Digit (MSI Plessey) 169  
Transmit Code 1D Char 160  
transmit LED 44  
Transmit Number System 178, 179  
trigger mappings 110  
triggers, configuring 109  
Trigger Type, Manage Triggers menu 112  
Trioptic Code 39, Enable 161  
IATA 2 of 5 156  
symbologies, bar code 144  
Sync Delay (Polling) 139  
system tray 69  
VIII Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
troubleshooting tips (scanning) 50  
2D PDF-417 170, 185, 194  
2D QR Code 195  
2D Raster Expand Rate 159  
2D UPC Half Block Stitching 167  
alpha keys, accessing 38  
uppercase letters, creating 39  
U
UCC 128(Code 128) 149  
UPC A 152, 164, 178  
UPC-A Check Digit 164  
UPC-A Preamble 164  
UPC E 152, 165, 178  
UPC-EAN 166, 192  
UPC-EAN Shared Settings 179  
UPC-E Check Digit 165  
UPC-E Preamble 165  
UPC-E1 Check Digit 165  
UPC-E1 Preamble 165  
UPC Half Block Stitching, 2D 167  
USB Setup Application D-1  
launching D-2  
approvals 238  
specifications 237  
802.1X authentication, enabling 22  
802.11 radio, configuring 17  
User security level 66  
V
Variations (Code 128) 149  
Verify 146  
W
warm reset 27  
Warm Reset (Shutdown menu) 73  
Window Delay (Polling) 140  
Window Height 188  
Windows® Start Menu See Start Menu 65  
Windows CE  
dialog box 73  
files, folders, & programs, working  
with 60  
Windows CE, navigating in 59  
Windows Explorer 68  
Window Width 188  
wireless connection setup 17  
Wireless Information Tab 19  
Wireless Properties tab 20  
WPA authentication 21  
WPA-PSK authentication 21  
1D Internal scanner, operating 50  
2D Aztec 195  
2D Codablock 186  
2D DataMatrix 194  
2D imager scanner, operating 51  
2D Maxicode 194  
Psion Teklogix 7530 G2 Hand-Held Computer User Manual  
IX  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Peavey Musical Instrument Amplifier Ecoustic 110 User Manual
Pelonis Electric Heater HC 0125D User Manual
Philips Battery Charger SCB5650NB 05 User Manual
Philips Cordless Telephone CD1504B User Manual
Philips MP3 Player ACT400 05 User Manual
Philips Speaker System HTL2151F7 User Manual
Poulan Chainsaw 115327926 User Manual
Poulan Lawn Mower 176873 User Manual
Poulan Trimmer 530163369 User Manual
PYLE Audio Automobile Accessories PNVS4 User Manual